xref: /netbsd-src/external/gpl3/binutils.old/dist/bfd/elf32-ppc.c (revision e992f068c547fd6e84b3f104dc2340adcc955732)
1 /* PowerPC-specific support for 32-bit ELF
2    Copyright (C) 1994-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3    Written by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support.
4 
5    This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6 
7    This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8    it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9    the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10    (at your option) any later version.
11 
12    This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14    MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
15    GNU General Public License for more details.
16 
17    You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18    along with this program; if not, write to the
19    Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor,
20    Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.  */
21 
22 /* The assembler should generate a full set of section symbols even
23    when they appear unused.  The linux kernel build tool recordmcount
24    needs them.  */
25 #define TARGET_KEEP_UNUSED_SECTION_SYMBOLS true
26 
27 #include "sysdep.h"
28 #include <stdarg.h>
29 #include "bfd.h"
30 #include "bfdlink.h"
31 #include "libbfd.h"
32 #include "elf-bfd.h"
33 #include "elf/ppc.h"
34 #include "elf32-ppc.h"
35 #include "elf-vxworks.h"
36 #include "dwarf2.h"
37 #include "opcode/ppc.h"
38 
39 /* All users of this file have bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, sec) == 1.  */
40 #define OCTETS_PER_BYTE(ABFD, SEC) 1
41 
42 typedef enum split16_format_type
43 {
44   split16a_type = 0,
45   split16d_type
46 }
47 split16_format_type;
48 
49 /* RELA relocations are used here.  */
50 
51 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc
52   (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
53 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc
54   (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
55 
56 /* Branch prediction bit for branch taken relocs.  */
57 #define BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT 0x200000
58 /* Mask to set RA in memory instructions.  */
59 #define RA_REGISTER_MASK 0x001f0000
60 /* Value to shift register by to insert RA.  */
61 #define RA_REGISTER_SHIFT 16
62 
63 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter.  This is put in the .interp
64    section.  */
65 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/usr/lib/ld.so.1"
66 
67 /* For old-style PLT.  */
68 /* The number of single-slot PLT entries (the rest use two slots).  */
69 #define PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES 8192
70 
71 /* For new-style .glink and .plt.  */
72 #define GLINK_PLTRESOLVE 16*4
73 #define GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE(htab, h)					\
74   ((4*4									\
75     + (h != NULL							\
76        && h == htab->tls_get_addr					\
77        && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt ? 8*4 : 0)			\
78     + (1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align) - 1)				\
79    & -(1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align))
80 
81 /* VxWorks uses its own plt layout, filled in by the static linker.  */
82 
83 /* The standard VxWorks PLT entry.  */
84 #define VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE 32
85 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry
86     [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
87   {
88     0x3d800000, /* lis	   r12,0		 */
89     0x818c0000, /* lwz	   r12,0(r12)		 */
90     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr   r12			 */
91     0x4e800420, /* bctr				 */
92     0x39600000, /* li	   r11,0		 */
93     0x48000000, /* b	   14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> */
94     0x60000000, /* nop				 */
95     0x60000000, /* nop				 */
96   };
97 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
98     [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
99   {
100     0x3d9e0000, /* addis r12,r30,0 */
101     0x818c0000, /* lwz	 r12,0(r12) */
102     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
103     0x4e800420, /* bctr */
104     0x39600000, /* li	 r11,0 */
105     0x48000000, /* b	 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> 14: R_PPC_REL24 .PLTresolve */
106     0x60000000, /* nop */
107     0x60000000, /* nop */
108   };
109 
110 /* The initial VxWorks PLT entry.  */
111 #define VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE 32
112 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry
113     [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
114   {
115     0x3d800000, /* lis	   r12,0	*/
116     0x398c0000, /* addi	   r12,r12,0	*/
117     0x800c0008, /* lwz	   r0,8(r12)	*/
118     0x7c0903a6, /* mtctr   r0		*/
119     0x818c0004, /* lwz	   r12,4(r12)	*/
120     0x4e800420, /* bctr			*/
121     0x60000000, /* nop			*/
122     0x60000000, /* nop			*/
123   };
124 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
125     [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
126   {
127     0x819e0008, /* lwz	 r12,8(r30) */
128     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12	    */
129     0x819e0004, /* lwz	 r12,4(r30) */
130     0x4e800420, /* bctr		    */
131     0x60000000, /* nop		    */
132     0x60000000, /* nop		    */
133     0x60000000, /* nop		    */
134     0x60000000, /* nop		    */
135   };
136 
137 /* For executables, we have some additional relocations in
138    .rela.plt.unloaded, for the kernel loader.  */
139 
140 /* The number of non-JMP_SLOT relocations per PLT0 slot. */
141 #define VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS 3
142 /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot. */
143 #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS 2
144 /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot when creating
145    a shared library. */
146 #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS_SHLIB 0
147 
148 /* Some instructions.  */
149 #define ADDIS_11_11	0x3d6b0000
150 #define ADDIS_11_30	0x3d7e0000
151 #define ADDIS_12_12	0x3d8c0000
152 #define ADDI_11_11	0x396b0000
153 #define ADD_0_11_11	0x7c0b5a14
154 #define ADD_3_12_2	0x7c6c1214
155 #define ADD_11_0_11	0x7d605a14
156 #define B		0x48000000
157 #define BA		0x48000002
158 #define BCL_20_31	0x429f0005
159 #define BCTR		0x4e800420
160 #define BEQLR		0x4d820020
161 #define CMPWI_11_0	0x2c0b0000
162 #define LIS_11		0x3d600000
163 #define LIS_12		0x3d800000
164 #define LWZU_0_12	0x840c0000
165 #define LWZ_0_12	0x800c0000
166 #define LWZ_11_3	0x81630000
167 #define LWZ_11_11	0x816b0000
168 #define LWZ_11_30	0x817e0000
169 #define LWZ_12_3	0x81830000
170 #define LWZ_12_12	0x818c0000
171 #define MR_0_3		0x7c601b78
172 #define MR_3_0		0x7c030378
173 #define MFLR_0		0x7c0802a6
174 #define MFLR_12		0x7d8802a6
175 #define MTCTR_0		0x7c0903a6
176 #define MTCTR_11	0x7d6903a6
177 #define MTLR_0		0x7c0803a6
178 #define NOP		0x60000000
179 #define SUB_11_11_12	0x7d6c5850
180 
181 /* Offset of tp and dtp pointers from start of TLS block.  */
182 #define TP_OFFSET	0x7000
183 #define DTP_OFFSET	0x8000
184 
185 /* The value of a defined global symbol.  */
186 #define SYM_VAL(SYM) \
187   ((SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma	\
188    + (SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_offset		\
189    + (SYM)->root.u.def.value)
190 
191 /* Relocation HOWTO's.  */
192 /* Like other ELF RELA targets that don't apply multiple
193    field-altering relocations to the same localation, src_mask is
194    always zero and pcrel_offset is the same as pc_relative.
195    PowerPC can always use a zero bitpos, even when the field is not at
196    the LSB.  For example, a REL24 could use rightshift=2, bisize=24
197    and bitpos=2 which matches the ABI description, or as we do here,
198    rightshift=0, bitsize=26 and bitpos=0.  */
199 #define HOW(type, size, bitsize, mask, rightshift, pc_relative, \
200 	    complain, special_func)				\
201   HOWTO (type, rightshift, size, bitsize, pc_relative, 0,	\
202 	 complain_overflow_ ## complain, special_func,		\
203 	 #type, false, 0, mask, pc_relative)
204 
205 static reloc_howto_type *ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_max];
206 
207 static reloc_howto_type ppc_elf_howto_raw[] = {
208   /* This reloc does nothing.  */
209   HOW (R_PPC_NONE, 0, 0, 0, 0, false, dont,
210        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
211 
212   /* A standard 32 bit relocation.  */
213   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
214        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
215 
216   /* An absolute 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
217      FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them.  */
218   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR24, 4, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, false, signed,
219        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
220 
221   /* A standard 16 bit relocation.  */
222   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, bitfield,
223        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
224 
225   /* A 16 bit relocation without overflow.  */
226   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
227        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
228 
229   /* The high order 16 bits of an address.  */
230   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
231        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
232 
233   /* The high order 16 bits of an address, plus 1 if the contents of
234      the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative.  */
235   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
236        ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
237 
238   /* An absolute 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
239      FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them.  */
240   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed,
241        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
242 
243   /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
244      indicate that the branch is expected to be taken.	The lower two
245      bits must be zero.  */
246   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed,
247        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
248 
249   /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
250      indicate that the branch is not expected to be taken.  The lower
251      two bits must be zero.  */
252   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed,
253        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
254 
255   /* A relative 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.  */
256   HOW (R_PPC_REL24, 4, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, true, signed,
257        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
258 
259   /* A relative 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.  */
260   HOW (R_PPC_REL14, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, true, signed,
261        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
262 
263   /* A relative 16 bit branch.  Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
264      the branch is expected to be taken.  The lower two bits must be
265      zero.  */
266   HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, true, signed,
267        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
268 
269   /* A relative 16 bit branch.  Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
270      the branch is not expected to be taken.  The lower two bits must
271      be zero.  */
272   HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, true, signed,
273        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
274 
275   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but referring to the GOT table entry for the
276      symbol.  */
277   HOW (R_PPC_GOT16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
278        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
279 
280   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the GOT table entry for
281      the symbol.  */
282   HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
283        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
284 
285   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the GOT table entry for
286      the symbol.  */
287   HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
288        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
289 
290   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the GOT table entry for
291      the symbol.  */
292   HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
293        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
294 
295   /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but referring to the procedure linkage table
296      entry for the symbol.  */
297   HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL24, 4, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, true, signed,
298        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
299 
300   /* This is used only by the dynamic linker.  The symbol should exist
301      both in the object being run and in some shared library.  The
302      dynamic linker copies the data addressed by the symbol from the
303      shared library into the object, because the object being
304      run has to have the data at some particular address.  */
305   HOW (R_PPC_COPY, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
306        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
307 
308   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but used when setting global offset table
309      entries.  */
310   HOW (R_PPC_GLOB_DAT, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
311        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
312 
313   /* Marks a procedure linkage table entry for a symbol.  */
314   HOW (R_PPC_JMP_SLOT, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
315        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
316 
317   /* Used only by the dynamic linker.  When the object is run, this
318      longword is set to the load address of the object, plus the
319      addend.  */
320   HOW (R_PPC_RELATIVE, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
321        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
322 
323   /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but uses the value of the symbol within the
324      object rather than the final value.  Normally used for
325      _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_.  */
326   HOW (R_PPC_LOCAL24PC, 4, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, true, signed,
327        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
328 
329   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but may be unaligned.  */
330   HOW (R_PPC_UADDR32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
331        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
332 
333   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but may be unaligned.  */
334   HOW (R_PPC_UADDR16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, bitfield,
335        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
336 
337   /* 32-bit PC relative */
338   HOW (R_PPC_REL32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, true, dont,
339        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
340 
341   /* 32-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
342      FIXME: not supported.  */
343   HOW (R_PPC_PLT32, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
344        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
345 
346   /* 32-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
347      FIXME: not supported.  */
348   HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL32, 4, 32, 0, 0, true, dont,
349        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
350 
351   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the PLT table entry for
352      the symbol.  */
353   HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
354        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
355 
356   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the PLT table entry for
357      the symbol.  */
358   HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
359        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
360 
361   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the PLT table entry for
362      the symbol.  */
363   HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
364        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
365 
366   /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA_BASE_, for use with
367      small data items.  */
368   HOW (R_PPC_SDAREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
369        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
370 
371   /* 16-bit section relative relocation.  */
372   HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
373        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
374 
375   /* 16-bit lower half section relative relocation.  */
376   HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
377        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
378 
379   /* 16-bit upper half section relative relocation.  */
380   HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
381        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
382 
383   /* 16-bit upper half adjusted section relative relocation.  */
384   HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
385        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
386 
387   /* Marker relocs for TLS.  */
388   HOW (R_PPC_TLS, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
389        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
390 
391   HOW (R_PPC_TLSGD, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
392        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
393 
394   HOW (R_PPC_TLSLD, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
395        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
396 
397   /* Marker relocs on inline plt call instructions.  */
398   HOW (R_PPC_PLTSEQ, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
399        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
400 
401   HOW (R_PPC_PLTCALL, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
402        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
403 
404   /* Computes the load module index of the load module that contains the
405      definition of its TLS sym.  */
406   HOW (R_PPC_DTPMOD32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
407        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
408 
409   /* Computes a dtv-relative displacement, the difference between the value
410      of sym+add and the base address of the thread-local storage block that
411      contains the definition of sym, minus 0x8000.  */
412   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
413        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
414 
415   /* A 16 bit dtprel reloc.  */
416   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
417        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
418 
419   /* Like DTPREL16, but no overflow.  */
420   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
421        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
422 
423   /* Like DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
424   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
425        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
426 
427   /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
428   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
429        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
430 
431   /* Computes a tp-relative displacement, the difference between the value of
432      sym+add and the value of the thread pointer (r13).  */
433   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
434        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
435 
436   /* A 16 bit tprel reloc.  */
437   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
438        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
439 
440   /* Like TPREL16, but no overflow.  */
441   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
442        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
443 
444   /* Like TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
445   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
446        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
447 
448   /* Like TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
449   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
450        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
451 
452   /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
453      with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes the offset
454      to the first entry.  */
455   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
456        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
457 
458   /* Like GOT_TLSGD16, but no overflow.  */
459   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
460        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
461 
462   /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
463   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
464        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
465 
466   /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
467   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
468        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
469 
470   /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
471      with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and zero, and computes the offset to the
472      first entry.  */
473   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
474        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
475 
476   /* Like GOT_TLSLD16, but no overflow.  */
477   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
478        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
479 
480   /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
481   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
482        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
483 
484   /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
485   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
486        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
487 
488   /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes
489      the offset to the entry.  */
490   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
491        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
492 
493   /* Like GOT_DTPREL16, but no overflow.  */
494   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
495        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
496 
497   /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
498   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
499        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
500 
501   /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
502   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
503        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
504 
505   /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@tprel, and computes the
506      offset to the entry.  */
507   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
508        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
509 
510   /* Like GOT_TPREL16, but no overflow.  */
511   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
512        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
513 
514   /* Like GOT_TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
515   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
516        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
517 
518   /* Like GOT_TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
519   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
520        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
521 
522   /* The remaining relocs are from the Embedded ELF ABI, and are not
523      in the SVR4 ELF ABI.  */
524 
525   /* 32 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol.  */
526   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
527        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
528 
529   /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol.  */
530   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
531        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
532 
533   /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol.  */
534   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
535        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
536 
537   /* The high order 16 bits of the addend minus the symbol.  */
538   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
539        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
540 
541   /* The high order 16 bits of the result of the addend minus the address,
542      plus 1 if the contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number,
543      is negative.  */
544   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
545        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
546 
547   /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
548      address in the .sdata section, and returning the offset from
549      _SDA_BASE_ for that relocation.  */
550   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
551        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
552 
553   /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
554      address in the .sdata2 section, and returning the offset from
555      _SDA2_BASE_ for that relocation.  */
556   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
557        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
558 
559   /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA2_BASE_, for use with
560      small data items.	 */
561   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
562        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
563 
564   /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling in the 16 bit
565      signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the register
566      field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13).  */
567   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA21, 4, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
568        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
569 
570   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF */
571   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16 */
572   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO */
573   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI */
574   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA */
575   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD */
576 
577   /* PC relative relocation against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling
578      in the 16 bit signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the
579      register field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13).  */
580   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
581        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
582 
583   /* A relative 8 bit branch.  */
584   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL8, 2, 8, 0xff, 1, true, signed,
585        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
586 
587   /* A relative 15 bit branch.  */
588   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL15, 4, 16, 0xfffe, 0, true, signed,
589        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
590 
591   /* A relative 24 bit branch.  */
592   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL24, 4, 25, 0x1fffffe, 0, true, signed,
593        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
594 
595   /* The 16 LSBS in split16a format.  */
596   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, false, dont,
597        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
598 
599   /* The 16 LSBS in split16d format.  */
600   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, false, dont,
601        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
602 
603   /* Bits 16-31 split16a format.  */
604   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, false, dont,
605        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
606 
607   /* Bits 16-31 split16d format.  */
608   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, false, dont,
609        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
610 
611   /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16a format.  */
612   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, false, dont,
613        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
614 
615   /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16d format.  */
616   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, false, dont,
617        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
618 
619   /* This reloc is like R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 but only applies to e_add16i
620      instructions.  If the register base is 0 then the linker changes
621      the e_add16i to an e_li instruction.  */
622   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21, 4, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
623        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
624 
625   /* Like R_PPC_VLE_SDA21 but ignore overflow.  */
626   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO, 4, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
627        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
628 
629   /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format.  */
630   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, false, dont,
631        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
632 
633   /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format.  */
634   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, false, dont,
635        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
636 
637   /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format.  */
638   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, false, dont,
639        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
640 
641   /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format.  */
642   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, false, dont,
643        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
644 
645   /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16a format.  */
646   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, false, dont,
647        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
648 
649   /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16d format.  */
650   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, false, dont,
651        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
652 
653   /* e_li split20 format.  */
654   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20, 4, 20, 0x1f7fff, 0, false, dont,
655        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
656 
657   HOW (R_PPC_IRELATIVE, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
658        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
659 
660   /* A 16 bit relative relocation.  */
661   HOW (R_PPC_REL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, true, signed,
662        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
663 
664   /* A 16 bit relative relocation without overflow.  */
665   HOW (R_PPC_REL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, true, dont,
666        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
667 
668   /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address.  */
669   HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, true, dont,
670        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
671 
672   /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address, plus 1 if the contents of
673      the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative.  */
674   HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, true, dont,
675        ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
676 
677   /* Like R_PPC_REL16_HA but for split field in addpcis.  */
678   HOW (R_PPC_REL16DX_HA, 4, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, true, signed,
679        ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
680 
681   /* A split-field reloc for addpcis, non-relative (gas internal use only).  */
682   HOW (R_PPC_16DX_HA, 4, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, false, signed,
683        ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
684 
685   /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy.  */
686   HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 0, 0, 0, false, dont,
687        NULL),
688 
689   /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage.  */
690   HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 0, 0, 0, false, dont,
691        NULL),
692 
693   /* Phony reloc to handle AIX style TOC entries.  */
694   HOW (R_PPC_TOC16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
695        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
696 };
697 
698 /* Initialize the ppc_elf_howto_table, so that linear accesses can be done.  */
699 
700 static void
ppc_elf_howto_init(void)701 ppc_elf_howto_init (void)
702 {
703   unsigned int i, type;
704 
705   for (i = 0;
706        i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
707        i++)
708     {
709       type = ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].type;
710       if (type >= (sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table)
711 		   / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table[0])))
712 	abort ();
713       ppc_elf_howto_table[type] = &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
714     }
715 }
716 
717 static reloc_howto_type *
ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)718 ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
719 			   bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
720 {
721   enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r;
722 
723   /* Initialize howto table if not already done.  */
724   if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
725     ppc_elf_howto_init ();
726 
727   switch (code)
728     {
729     default:
730       return NULL;
731 
732     case BFD_RELOC_NONE:		r = R_PPC_NONE;			break;
733     case BFD_RELOC_32:			r = R_PPC_ADDR32;		break;
734     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA26:		r = R_PPC_ADDR24;		break;
735     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
736     case BFD_RELOC_16:			r = R_PPC_ADDR16;		break;
737     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
738     case BFD_RELOC_LO16:		r = R_PPC_ADDR16_LO;		break;
739     case BFD_RELOC_HI16:		r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HI;		break;
740     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S:		r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HA;		break;
741     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16:		r = R_PPC_ADDR14;		break;
742     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRTAKEN:	r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN;	break;
743     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRNTAKEN:	r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN;	break;
744     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B26:		r = R_PPC_REL24;		break;
745     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16:		r = R_PPC_REL14;		break;
746     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRTAKEN:	r = R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN;	break;
747     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRNTAKEN:	r = R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN;	break;
748     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
749     case BFD_RELOC_16_GOTOFF:		r = R_PPC_GOT16;		break;
750     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
751     case BFD_RELOC_LO16_GOTOFF:		r = R_PPC_GOT16_LO;		break;
752     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_GOTOFF:		r = R_PPC_GOT16_HI;		break;
753     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_GOTOFF:	r = R_PPC_GOT16_HA;		break;
754     case BFD_RELOC_24_PLT_PCREL:	r = R_PPC_PLTREL24;		break;
755     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_COPY:		r = R_PPC_COPY;			break;
756     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GLOB_DAT:	r = R_PPC_GLOB_DAT;		break;
757     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_LOCAL24PC:	r = R_PPC_LOCAL24PC;		break;
758     case BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL:		r = R_PPC_REL32;		break;
759     case BFD_RELOC_32_PLTOFF:		r = R_PPC_PLT32;		break;
760     case BFD_RELOC_32_PLT_PCREL:	r = R_PPC_PLTREL32;		break;
761     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
762     case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PLTOFF:		r = R_PPC_PLT16_LO;		break;
763     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PLTOFF:		r = R_PPC_PLT16_HI;		break;
764     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PLTOFF:	r = R_PPC_PLT16_HA;		break;
765     case BFD_RELOC_GPREL16:		r = R_PPC_SDAREL16;		break;
766     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
767     case BFD_RELOC_16_BASEREL:		r = R_PPC_SECTOFF;		break;
768     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
769     case BFD_RELOC_LO16_BASEREL:	r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO;		break;
770     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_BASEREL:	r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI;		break;
771     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_BASEREL:	r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA;		break;
772     case BFD_RELOC_CTOR:		r = R_PPC_ADDR32;		break;
773     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
774     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TOC16:		r = R_PPC_TOC16;		break;
775     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLS:		r = R_PPC_TLS;			break;
776     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSGD:		r = R_PPC_TLSGD;		break;
777     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSLD:		r = R_PPC_TLSLD;		break;
778     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPMOD:		r = R_PPC_DTPMOD32;		break;
779     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
780     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16:		r = R_PPC_TPREL16;		break;
781     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
782     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_LO:	r = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;		break;
783     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HI:	r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HI;		break;
784     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HA:	r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;		break;
785     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL:		r = R_PPC_TPREL32;		break;
786     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
787     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16:	r = R_PPC_DTPREL16;		break;
788     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
789     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:	r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO;		break;
790     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:	r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI;		break;
791     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:	r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA;		break;
792     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL:		r = R_PPC_DTPREL32;		break;
793     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16;		break;
794     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO;	break;
795     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI;	break;
796     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA;	break;
797     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16;		break;
798     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO;	break;
799     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI;	break;
800     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA;	break;
801     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16;		break;
802     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO;	break;
803     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI;	break;
804     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA;	break;
805     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:	r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16;		break;
806     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:	r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO;	break;
807     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:	r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI;	break;
808     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:	r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA;	break;
809     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32;		break;
810     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16;		break;
811     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO;	break;
812     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI;	break;
813     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA;	break;
814     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:	r = R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16;		break;
815     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:	r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16;		break;
816     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:	r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL;		break;
817     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA21:	r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA21;		break;
818     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:	r = R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF;		break;
819     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16;		break;
820     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO;		break;
821     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI;		break;
822     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA;		break;
823     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:	r = R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD;		break;
824     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA;		break;
825     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL8:	r = R_PPC_VLE_REL8;		break;
826     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL15:	r = R_PPC_VLE_REL15;		break;
827     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL24:	r = R_PPC_VLE_REL24;		break;
828     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16A:	r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16A;		break;
829     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16D:	r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16D;		break;
830     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16A:	r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16A;		break;
831     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16D:	r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16D;		break;
832     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16A:	r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16A;		break;
833     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16D:	r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16D;		break;
834     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21:	r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21;		break;
835     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:	r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO;		break;
836     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
837       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A;
838       break;
839     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
840       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D;
841       break;
842     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
843       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A;
844       break;
845     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
846       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D;
847       break;
848     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
849       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A;
850       break;
851     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
852       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D;
853       break;
854     case BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL:		r = R_PPC_REL16;		break;
855     case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PCREL:		r = R_PPC_REL16_LO;		break;
856     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PCREL:		r = R_PPC_REL16_HI;		break;
857     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PCREL:	r = R_PPC_REL16_HA;		break;
858     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_16DX_HA:		r = R_PPC_16DX_HA;		break;
859     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_REL16DX_HA:	r = R_PPC_REL16DX_HA;		break;
860     case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT:	r = R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT;	break;
861     case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY:	r = R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY;		break;
862     }
863 
864   return ppc_elf_howto_table[r];
865 };
866 
867 static reloc_howto_type *
ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const char * r_name)868 ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
869 			   const char *r_name)
870 {
871   unsigned int i;
872 
873   for (i = 0;
874        i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
875        i++)
876     if (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name != NULL
877 	&& strcasecmp (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name, r_name) == 0)
878       return &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
879 
880   return NULL;
881 }
882 
883 /* Set the howto pointer for a PowerPC ELF reloc.  */
884 
885 static bool
ppc_elf_info_to_howto(bfd * abfd,arelent * cache_ptr,Elf_Internal_Rela * dst)886 ppc_elf_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd,
887 		       arelent *cache_ptr,
888 		       Elf_Internal_Rela *dst)
889 {
890   unsigned int r_type;
891 
892   /* Initialize howto table if not already done.  */
893   if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
894     ppc_elf_howto_init ();
895 
896   r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info);
897   if (r_type >= R_PPC_max)
898     {
899       /* xgettext:c-format */
900       _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
901 			  abfd, r_type);
902       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
903       return false;
904     }
905 
906   cache_ptr->howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
907 
908   /* Just because the above assert didn't trigger doesn't mean that
909      ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info) is necessarily a valid relocation.  */
910   if (cache_ptr->howto == NULL)
911     {
912       /* xgettext:c-format */
913       _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
914 			  abfd, r_type);
915       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
916 
917       return false;
918     }
919 
920   return true;
921 }
922 
923 /* Handle the R_PPC_ADDR16_HA and R_PPC_REL16_HA relocs.  */
924 
925 static bfd_reloc_status_type
ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc(bfd * abfd,arelent * reloc_entry,asymbol * symbol,void * data,asection * input_section,bfd * output_bfd,char ** error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)926 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd,
927 			 arelent *reloc_entry,
928 			 asymbol *symbol,
929 			 void *data,
930 			 asection *input_section,
931 			 bfd *output_bfd,
932 			 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
933 {
934   enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
935   long insn;
936   bfd_size_type octets;
937   bfd_vma value;
938 
939   if (output_bfd != NULL)
940     {
941       reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
942       return bfd_reloc_ok;
943     }
944 
945   reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
946   r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
947   if (r_type != R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
948     return bfd_reloc_continue;
949 
950   value = 0;
951   if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
952     value = symbol->value;
953   value += (reloc_entry->addend
954 	    + symbol->section->output_offset
955 	    + symbol->section->output_section->vma);
956   value -= (reloc_entry->address
957 	    + input_section->output_offset
958 	    + input_section->output_section->vma);
959   value >>= 16;
960 
961   octets = reloc_entry->address * OCTETS_PER_BYTE (abfd, input_section);
962   if (!bfd_reloc_offset_in_range (reloc_entry->howto, abfd,
963 				  input_section, octets))
964     return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
965 
966   insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
967   insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
968   insn |= (value & 0xffc1) | ((value & 0x3e) << 15);
969   bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
970   return bfd_reloc_ok;
971 }
972 
973 static bfd_reloc_status_type
ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc(bfd * abfd,arelent * reloc_entry,asymbol * symbol,void * data,asection * input_section,bfd * output_bfd,char ** error_message)974 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc (bfd *abfd,
975 			 arelent *reloc_entry,
976 			 asymbol *symbol,
977 			 void *data,
978 			 asection *input_section,
979 			 bfd *output_bfd,
980 			 char **error_message)
981 {
982   /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
983      call the generic function.  Any adjustment will be done at final
984      link time.  */
985   if (output_bfd != NULL)
986     return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
987 				  input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
988 
989   if (error_message != NULL)
990     {
991       static char *message;
992       free (message);
993       if (asprintf (&message, _("generic linker can't handle %s"),
994 		    reloc_entry->howto->name) < 0)
995 	message = NULL;
996       *error_message = message;
997     }
998   return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
999 }
1000 
1001 /* Sections created by the linker.  */
1002 
1003 typedef struct elf_linker_section
1004 {
1005   /* Pointer to the bfd section.  */
1006   asection *section;
1007   /* Section name.  */
1008   const char *name;
1009   /* Associated bss section name.  */
1010   const char *bss_name;
1011   /* Associated symbol name.  */
1012   const char *sym_name;
1013   /* Associated symbol.  */
1014   struct elf_link_hash_entry *sym;
1015 } elf_linker_section_t;
1016 
1017 /* Linked list of allocated pointer entries.  This hangs off of the
1018    symbol lists, and provides allows us to return different pointers,
1019    based on different addend's.  */
1020 
1021 typedef struct elf_linker_section_pointers
1022 {
1023   /* next allocated pointer for this symbol */
1024   struct elf_linker_section_pointers *next;
1025   /* offset of pointer from beginning of section */
1026   bfd_vma offset;
1027   /* addend used */
1028   bfd_vma addend;
1029   /* which linker section this is */
1030   elf_linker_section_t *lsect;
1031 } elf_linker_section_pointers_t;
1032 
1033 struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata
1034 {
1035   struct elf_obj_tdata elf;
1036 
1037   /* A mapping from local symbols to offsets into the various linker
1038      sections added.  This is index by the symbol index.  */
1039   elf_linker_section_pointers_t **linker_section_pointers;
1040 
1041   /* Flags used to auto-detect plt type.  */
1042   unsigned int makes_plt_call : 1;
1043   unsigned int has_rel16 : 1;
1044 };
1045 
1046 #define ppc_elf_tdata(bfd) \
1047   ((struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any)
1048 
1049 #define elf_local_ptr_offsets(bfd) \
1050   (ppc_elf_tdata (bfd)->linker_section_pointers)
1051 
1052 #define is_ppc_elf(bfd) \
1053   (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
1054    && elf_object_id (bfd) == PPC32_ELF_DATA)
1055 
1056 /* Override the generic function because we store some extras.  */
1057 
1058 static bool
ppc_elf_mkobject(bfd * abfd)1059 ppc_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
1060 {
1061   return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata),
1062 				  PPC32_ELF_DATA);
1063 }
1064 
1065 /* When defaulting arch/mach, decode apuinfo to find a better match.  */
1066 
1067 bool
_bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch(bfd * abfd)1068 _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (bfd *abfd)
1069 {
1070   unsigned long mach = 0;
1071   asection *s;
1072   unsigned char *contents;
1073 
1074   if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32
1075       && bfd_big_endian (abfd))
1076     {
1077 
1078       for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
1079 	if ((elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1080 	  break;
1081       if (s != NULL)
1082 	mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1083     }
1084 
1085   if (mach == 0)
1086     {
1087       s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1088       if (s != NULL
1089 	  && s->size >= 24
1090 	  && bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &contents))
1091 	{
1092 	  unsigned int apuinfo_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + 4);
1093 	  unsigned int i;
1094 
1095 	  for (i = 20; i < apuinfo_size + 20 && i + 4 <= s->size; i += 4)
1096 	    {
1097 	      unsigned int val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + i);
1098 	      switch (val >> 16)
1099 		{
1100 		case PPC_APUINFO_PMR:
1101 		case PPC_APUINFO_RFMCI:
1102 		  if (mach == 0)
1103 		    mach = bfd_mach_ppc_titan;
1104 		  break;
1105 
1106 		case PPC_APUINFO_ISEL:
1107 		case PPC_APUINFO_CACHELCK:
1108 		  if (mach == bfd_mach_ppc_titan)
1109 		    mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500mc;
1110 		  break;
1111 
1112 		case PPC_APUINFO_SPE:
1113 		case PPC_APUINFO_EFS:
1114 		case PPC_APUINFO_BRLOCK:
1115 		  if (mach != bfd_mach_ppc_vle)
1116 		    mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500;
1117 		  break;
1118 
1119 		case PPC_APUINFO_VLE:
1120 		  mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1121 		  break;
1122 
1123 		default:
1124 		  mach = -1ul;
1125 		}
1126 	    }
1127 	  free (contents);
1128 	}
1129     }
1130 
1131   if (mach != 0 && mach != -1ul)
1132     {
1133       const bfd_arch_info_type *arch;
1134 
1135       for (arch = abfd->arch_info->next; arch; arch = arch->next)
1136 	if (arch->mach == mach)
1137 	  {
1138 	    abfd->arch_info = arch;
1139 	    break;
1140 	  }
1141     }
1142   return true;
1143 }
1144 
1145 /* Fix bad default arch selected for a 32 bit input bfd when the
1146    default is 64 bit.  Also select arch based on apuinfo.  */
1147 
1148 static bool
ppc_elf_object_p(bfd * abfd)1149 ppc_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
1150 {
1151   if (!abfd->arch_info->the_default)
1152     return true;
1153 
1154   if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 64)
1155     {
1156       Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
1157 
1158       if (i_ehdr->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
1159 	{
1160 	  /* Relies on arch after 64 bit default being 32 bit default.  */
1161 	  abfd->arch_info = abfd->arch_info->next;
1162 	  BFD_ASSERT (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32);
1163 	}
1164     }
1165   return _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (abfd);
1166 }
1167 
1168 /* Function to set whether a module needs the -mrelocatable bit set.  */
1169 
1170 static bool
ppc_elf_set_private_flags(bfd * abfd,flagword flags)1171 ppc_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
1172 {
1173   BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
1174 	      || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
1175 
1176   elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
1177   elf_flags_init (abfd) = true;
1178   return true;
1179 }
1180 
1181 /* Support for core dump NOTE sections.  */
1182 
1183 static bool
ppc_elf_grok_prstatus(bfd * abfd,Elf_Internal_Note * note)1184 ppc_elf_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1185 {
1186   int offset;
1187   unsigned int size;
1188 
1189   switch (note->descsz)
1190     {
1191     default:
1192       return false;
1193 
1194     case 268:		/* Linux/PPC.  */
1195       /* pr_cursig */
1196       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
1197 
1198       /* pr_pid */
1199       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
1200 
1201       /* pr_reg */
1202       offset = 72;
1203       size = 192;
1204 
1205       break;
1206     }
1207 
1208   /* Make a ".reg/999" section.  */
1209   return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
1210 					  size, note->descpos + offset);
1211 }
1212 
1213 static bool
ppc_elf_grok_psinfo(bfd * abfd,Elf_Internal_Note * note)1214 ppc_elf_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1215 {
1216   switch (note->descsz)
1217     {
1218     default:
1219       return false;
1220 
1221     case 128:		/* Linux/PPC elf_prpsinfo.  */
1222       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
1223 	= bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 16);
1224       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
1225 	= _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 32, 16);
1226       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
1227 	= _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 48, 80);
1228     }
1229 
1230   /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
1231      onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
1232      implementations, so strip it off if it exists.  */
1233 
1234   {
1235     char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
1236     int n = strlen (command);
1237 
1238     if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
1239       command[n - 1] = '\0';
1240   }
1241 
1242   return true;
1243 }
1244 
1245 static char *
ppc_elf_write_core_note(bfd * abfd,char * buf,int * bufsiz,int note_type,...)1246 ppc_elf_write_core_note (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz, int note_type, ...)
1247 {
1248   switch (note_type)
1249     {
1250     default:
1251       return NULL;
1252 
1253     case NT_PRPSINFO:
1254       {
1255 	char data[128] ATTRIBUTE_NONSTRING;
1256 	va_list ap;
1257 
1258 	va_start (ap, note_type);
1259 	memset (data, 0, sizeof (data));
1260 	strncpy (data + 32, va_arg (ap, const char *), 16);
1261 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1262 	DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH;
1263 	/* GCC 8.0 and 8.1 warn about 80 equals destination size with
1264 	   -Wstringop-truncation:
1265 	   https://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=85643
1266 	 */
1267 	DIAGNOSTIC_IGNORE_STRINGOP_TRUNCATION;
1268 #endif
1269 	strncpy (data + 48, va_arg (ap, const char *), 80);
1270 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1271 	DIAGNOSTIC_POP;
1272 #endif
1273 	va_end (ap);
1274 	return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1275 				   "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1276       }
1277 
1278     case NT_PRSTATUS:
1279       {
1280 	char data[268];
1281 	va_list ap;
1282 	long pid;
1283 	int cursig;
1284 	const void *greg;
1285 
1286 	va_start (ap, note_type);
1287 	memset (data, 0, 72);
1288 	pid = va_arg (ap, long);
1289 	bfd_put_32 (abfd, pid, data + 24);
1290 	cursig = va_arg (ap, int);
1291 	bfd_put_16 (abfd, cursig, data + 12);
1292 	greg = va_arg (ap, const void *);
1293 	memcpy (data + 72, greg, 192);
1294 	memset (data + 264, 0, 4);
1295 	va_end (ap);
1296 	return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1297 				   "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1298       }
1299     }
1300 }
1301 
1302 static flagword
ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags(char * flag_name)1303 ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags (char *flag_name)
1304 {
1305 
1306   if (!strcmp (flag_name, "SHF_PPC_VLE"))
1307     return SHF_PPC_VLE;
1308 
1309   return 0;
1310 }
1311 
1312 /* Return address for Ith PLT stub in section PLT, for relocation REL
1313    or (bfd_vma) -1 if it should not be included.  */
1314 
1315 static bfd_vma
ppc_elf_plt_sym_val(bfd_vma i ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const asection * plt ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const arelent * rel)1316 ppc_elf_plt_sym_val (bfd_vma i ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1317 		     const asection *plt ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1318 		     const arelent *rel)
1319 {
1320   return rel->address;
1321 }
1322 
1323 /* Handle a PowerPC specific section when reading an object file.  This
1324    is called when bfd_section_from_shdr finds a section with an unknown
1325    type.  */
1326 
1327 static bool
ppc_elf_section_from_shdr(bfd * abfd,Elf_Internal_Shdr * hdr,const char * name,int shindex)1328 ppc_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
1329 			   Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
1330 			   const char *name,
1331 			   int shindex)
1332 {
1333   asection *newsect;
1334   flagword flags;
1335 
1336   if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1337     return false;
1338 
1339   newsect = hdr->bfd_section;
1340   flags = 0;
1341   if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE)
1342     flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1343 
1344   if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_ORDERED)
1345     flags |= SEC_SORT_ENTRIES;
1346 
1347   if (startswith (name, ".PPC.EMB"))
1348     name += 8;
1349   if (startswith (name, ".sbss")
1350       || startswith (name, ".sdata"))
1351     flags |= SEC_SMALL_DATA;
1352 
1353   return (flags == 0
1354 	  || bfd_set_section_flags (newsect, newsect->flags | flags));
1355 }
1356 
1357 /* Set up any other section flags and such that may be necessary.  */
1358 
1359 static bool
ppc_elf_fake_sections(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,Elf_Internal_Shdr * shdr,asection * asect)1360 ppc_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1361 		       Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr,
1362 		       asection *asect)
1363 {
1364   if ((asect->flags & SEC_SORT_ENTRIES) != 0)
1365     shdr->sh_type = SHT_ORDERED;
1366 
1367   return true;
1368 }
1369 
1370 /* If we have .sbss2 or .PPC.EMB.sbss0 output sections, we
1371    need to bump up the number of section headers.  */
1372 
1373 static int
ppc_elf_additional_program_headers(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)1374 ppc_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
1375 				    struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1376 {
1377   asection *s;
1378   int ret = 0;
1379 
1380   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".sbss2");
1381   if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1382     ++ret;
1383 
1384   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0");
1385   if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1386     ++ret;
1387 
1388   return ret;
1389 }
1390 
1391 /* Modify the segment map for VLE executables.  */
1392 
1393 bool
ppc_elf_modify_segment_map(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)1394 ppc_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
1395 			    struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1396 {
1397   struct elf_segment_map *m;
1398 
1399   /* At this point in the link, output sections have already been sorted by
1400      LMA and assigned to segments.  All that is left to do is to ensure
1401      there is no mixing of VLE & non-VLE sections in a text segment.
1402      If we find that case, we split the segment.
1403      We maintain the original output section order.  */
1404 
1405   for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
1406     {
1407       struct elf_segment_map *n;
1408       size_t amt;
1409       unsigned int j, k;
1410       unsigned int p_flags;
1411 
1412       if (m->p_type != PT_LOAD || m->count == 0)
1413 	continue;
1414 
1415       for (p_flags = PF_R, j = 0; j != m->count; ++j)
1416 	{
1417 	  if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1418 	    p_flags |= PF_W;
1419 	  if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1420 	    {
1421 	      p_flags |= PF_X;
1422 	      if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1423 		p_flags |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1424 	      break;
1425 	    }
1426 	}
1427       if (j != m->count)
1428 	while (++j != m->count)
1429 	  {
1430 	    unsigned int p_flags1 = PF_R;
1431 
1432 	    if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1433 	      p_flags1 |= PF_W;
1434 	    if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1435 	      {
1436 		p_flags1 |= PF_X;
1437 		if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1438 		  p_flags1 |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1439 		if (((p_flags1 ^ p_flags) & PF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1440 		  break;
1441 	      }
1442 	    p_flags |= p_flags1;
1443 	  }
1444       /* If we're splitting a segment which originally contained rw
1445 	 sections then those sections might now only be in one of the
1446 	 two parts.  So always set p_flags if splitting, even if we
1447 	 are being called for objcopy with p_flags_valid set.  */
1448       if (j != m->count || !m->p_flags_valid)
1449 	{
1450 	  m->p_flags_valid = 1;
1451 	  m->p_flags = p_flags;
1452 	}
1453       if (j == m->count)
1454 	continue;
1455 
1456       /* Sections 0..j-1 stay in this (current) segment,
1457 	 the remainder are put in a new segment.
1458 	 The scan resumes with the new segment.  */
1459 
1460       amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
1461       amt += (m->count - j - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
1462       n = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
1463       if (n == NULL)
1464 	return false;
1465 
1466       n->p_type = PT_LOAD;
1467       n->count = m->count - j;
1468       for (k = 0; k < n->count; ++k)
1469 	n->sections[k] = m->sections[j + k];
1470       m->count = j;
1471       m->p_size_valid = 0;
1472       n->next = m->next;
1473       m->next = n;
1474     }
1475 
1476   return true;
1477 }
1478 
1479 /* Add extra PPC sections -- Note, for now, make .sbss2 and
1480    .PPC.EMB.sbss0 a normal section, and not a bss section so
1481    that the linker doesn't crater when trying to make more than
1482    2 sections.  */
1483 
1484 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_elf_special_sections[] =
1485 {
1486   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
1487   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1488   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1489   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1490   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1491   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tags"), 0, SHT_ORDERED, SHF_ALLOC },
1492   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (APUINFO_SECTION_NAME), 0, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
1493   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sbss0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1494   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sdata0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1495   { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
1496 };
1497 
1498 /* This is what we want for new plt/got.  */
1499 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_alt_plt =
1500   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"),		   0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC };
1501 
1502 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr(bfd * abfd,asection * sec)1503 ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
1504 {
1505   const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
1506 
1507   /* See if this is one of the special sections.  */
1508   if (sec->name == NULL)
1509     return NULL;
1510 
1511   ssect = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, ppc_elf_special_sections,
1512 					sec->use_rela_p);
1513   if (ssect != NULL)
1514     {
1515       if (ssect == ppc_elf_special_sections && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
1516 	ssect = &ppc_alt_plt;
1517       return ssect;
1518     }
1519 
1520   return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
1521 }
1522 
1523 /* Very simple linked list structure for recording apuinfo values.  */
1524 typedef struct apuinfo_list
1525 {
1526   struct apuinfo_list *next;
1527   unsigned long value;
1528 }
1529 apuinfo_list;
1530 
1531 static apuinfo_list *head;
1532 static bool apuinfo_set;
1533 
1534 static void
apuinfo_list_init(void)1535 apuinfo_list_init (void)
1536 {
1537   head = NULL;
1538   apuinfo_set = false;
1539 }
1540 
1541 static void
apuinfo_list_add(unsigned long value)1542 apuinfo_list_add (unsigned long value)
1543 {
1544   apuinfo_list *entry = head;
1545 
1546   while (entry != NULL)
1547     {
1548       if (entry->value == value)
1549 	return;
1550       entry = entry->next;
1551     }
1552 
1553   entry = bfd_malloc (sizeof (* entry));
1554   if (entry == NULL)
1555     return;
1556 
1557   entry->value = value;
1558   entry->next  = head;
1559   head = entry;
1560 }
1561 
1562 static unsigned
apuinfo_list_length(void)1563 apuinfo_list_length (void)
1564 {
1565   apuinfo_list *entry;
1566   unsigned long count;
1567 
1568   for (entry = head, count = 0;
1569        entry;
1570        entry = entry->next)
1571     ++ count;
1572 
1573   return count;
1574 }
1575 
1576 static inline unsigned long
apuinfo_list_element(unsigned long number)1577 apuinfo_list_element (unsigned long number)
1578 {
1579   apuinfo_list * entry;
1580 
1581   for (entry = head;
1582        entry && number --;
1583        entry = entry->next)
1584     ;
1585 
1586   return entry ? entry->value : 0;
1587 }
1588 
1589 static void
apuinfo_list_finish(void)1590 apuinfo_list_finish (void)
1591 {
1592   apuinfo_list *entry;
1593 
1594   for (entry = head; entry;)
1595     {
1596       apuinfo_list *next = entry->next;
1597       free (entry);
1598       entry = next;
1599     }
1600 
1601   head = NULL;
1602 }
1603 
1604 /* Scan the input BFDs and create a linked list of
1605    the APUinfo values that will need to be emitted.  */
1606 
1607 static void
ppc_elf_begin_write_processing(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * link_info)1608 ppc_elf_begin_write_processing (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
1609 {
1610   bfd *ibfd;
1611   asection *asec;
1612   char *buffer = NULL;
1613   bfd_size_type largest_input_size = 0;
1614   unsigned i;
1615   unsigned long length;
1616   const char *error_message = NULL;
1617 
1618   if (link_info == NULL)
1619     return;
1620 
1621   apuinfo_list_init ();
1622 
1623   /* Read in the input sections contents.  */
1624   for (ibfd = link_info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
1625     {
1626       unsigned long datum;
1627 
1628       asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1629       if (asec == NULL)
1630 	continue;
1631 
1632       /* xgettext:c-format */
1633       error_message = _("corrupt %s section in %pB");
1634       length = asec->size;
1635       if (length < 20)
1636 	goto fail;
1637 
1638       apuinfo_set = true;
1639       if (largest_input_size < asec->size)
1640 	{
1641 	  free (buffer);
1642 	  largest_input_size = asec->size;
1643 	  buffer = bfd_malloc (largest_input_size);
1644 	  if (!buffer)
1645 	    return;
1646 	}
1647 
1648       if (bfd_seek (ibfd, asec->filepos, SEEK_SET) != 0
1649 	  || (bfd_bread (buffer, length, ibfd) != length))
1650 	{
1651 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
1652 	  error_message = _("unable to read in %s section from %pB");
1653 	  goto fail;
1654 	}
1655 
1656       /* Verify the contents of the header.  Note - we have to
1657 	 extract the values this way in order to allow for a
1658 	 host whose endian-ness is different from the target.  */
1659       datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer);
1660       if (datum != sizeof APUINFO_LABEL)
1661 	goto fail;
1662 
1663       datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 8);
1664       if (datum != 0x2)
1665 	goto fail;
1666 
1667       if (strcmp (buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL) != 0)
1668 	goto fail;
1669 
1670       /* Get the number of bytes used for apuinfo entries.  */
1671       datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 4);
1672       if (datum + 20 != length)
1673 	goto fail;
1674 
1675       /* Scan the apuinfo section, building a list of apuinfo numbers.  */
1676       for (i = 0; i < datum; i += 4)
1677 	apuinfo_list_add (bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 20 + i));
1678     }
1679 
1680   error_message = NULL;
1681 
1682   if (apuinfo_set)
1683     {
1684       /* Compute the size of the output section.  */
1685       unsigned num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1686 
1687       /* Set the output section size, if it exists.  */
1688       asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1689 
1690       if (asec && !bfd_set_section_size (asec, 20 + num_entries * 4))
1691 	{
1692 	  ibfd = abfd;
1693 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
1694 	  error_message = _("warning: unable to set size of %s section in %pB");
1695 	}
1696     }
1697 
1698  fail:
1699   free (buffer);
1700 
1701   if (error_message)
1702     _bfd_error_handler (error_message, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME, ibfd);
1703 }
1704 
1705 /* Prevent the output section from accumulating the input sections'
1706    contents.  We have already stored this in our linked list structure.  */
1707 
1708 static bool
ppc_elf_write_section(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,struct bfd_link_info * link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection * asec,bfd_byte * contents ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)1709 ppc_elf_write_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1710 		       struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1711 		       asection *asec,
1712 		       bfd_byte *contents ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1713 {
1714   return apuinfo_set && strcmp (asec->name, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME) == 0;
1715 }
1716 
1717 /* Finally we can generate the output section.  */
1718 
1719 static void
ppc_final_write_processing(bfd * abfd)1720 ppc_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
1721 {
1722   bfd_byte *buffer;
1723   asection *asec;
1724   unsigned i;
1725   unsigned num_entries;
1726   bfd_size_type length;
1727 
1728   asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1729   if (asec == NULL)
1730     return;
1731 
1732   if (!apuinfo_set)
1733     return;
1734 
1735   length = asec->size;
1736   if (length < 20)
1737     return;
1738 
1739   buffer = bfd_malloc (length);
1740   if (buffer == NULL)
1741     {
1742       _bfd_error_handler
1743 	(_("failed to allocate space for new APUinfo section"));
1744       return;
1745     }
1746 
1747   /* Create the apuinfo header.  */
1748   num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1749   bfd_put_32 (abfd, sizeof APUINFO_LABEL, buffer);
1750   bfd_put_32 (abfd, num_entries * 4, buffer + 4);
1751   bfd_put_32 (abfd, 0x2, buffer + 8);
1752   strcpy ((char *) buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL);
1753 
1754   length = 20;
1755   for (i = 0; i < num_entries; i++)
1756     {
1757       bfd_put_32 (abfd, apuinfo_list_element (i), buffer + length);
1758       length += 4;
1759     }
1760 
1761   if (length != asec->size)
1762     _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to compute new APUinfo section"));
1763 
1764   if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, asec, buffer, (file_ptr) 0, length))
1765     _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to install new APUinfo section"));
1766 
1767   free (buffer);
1768 
1769   apuinfo_list_finish ();
1770 }
1771 
1772 static bool
ppc_elf_final_write_processing(bfd * abfd)1773 ppc_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
1774 {
1775   ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
1776   return _bfd_elf_final_write_processing (abfd);
1777 }
1778 
1779 static bool
is_nonpic_glink_stub(bfd * abfd,asection * glink,bfd_vma off)1780 is_nonpic_glink_stub (bfd *abfd, asection *glink, bfd_vma off)
1781 {
1782   bfd_byte buf[4 * 4];
1783 
1784   if (!bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf, off, sizeof buf))
1785     return false;
1786 
1787   return ((bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 0) & 0xffff0000) == LIS_11
1788 	  && (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 4) & 0xffff0000) == LWZ_11_11
1789 	  && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 8) == MTCTR_11
1790 	  && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 12) == BCTR);
1791 }
1792 
1793 static bool
section_covers_vma(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection * section,void * ptr)1794 section_covers_vma (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section, void *ptr)
1795 {
1796   bfd_vma vma = *(bfd_vma *) ptr;
1797   return ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
1798 	  && section->vma <= vma
1799 	  && vma < section->vma + section->size);
1800 }
1801 
1802 static long
ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab(bfd * abfd,long symcount,asymbol ** syms,long dynsymcount,asymbol ** dynsyms,asymbol ** ret)1803 ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd, long symcount, asymbol **syms,
1804 			      long dynsymcount, asymbol **dynsyms,
1805 			      asymbol **ret)
1806 {
1807   bool (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bool);
1808   asection *plt, *relplt, *dynamic, *glink;
1809   bfd_vma glink_vma = 0;
1810   bfd_vma resolv_vma = 0;
1811   bfd_vma stub_off;
1812   asymbol *s;
1813   arelent *p;
1814   size_t count, i, stub_delta;
1815   size_t size;
1816   char *names;
1817   bfd_byte buf[4];
1818 
1819   *ret = NULL;
1820 
1821   if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
1822     return 0;
1823 
1824   if (dynsymcount <= 0)
1825     return 0;
1826 
1827   relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
1828   if (relplt == NULL)
1829     return 0;
1830 
1831   plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
1832   if (plt == NULL)
1833     return 0;
1834 
1835   /* Call common code to handle old-style executable PLTs.  */
1836   if (elf_section_flags (plt) & SHF_EXECINSTR)
1837     return _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (abfd, symcount, syms,
1838 					  dynsymcount, dynsyms, ret);
1839 
1840   /* If this object was prelinked, the prelinker stored the address
1841      of .glink at got[1].  If it wasn't prelinked, got[1] will be zero.  */
1842   dynamic = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1843   if (dynamic != NULL)
1844     {
1845       bfd_byte *dynbuf, *extdyn, *extdynend;
1846       size_t extdynsize;
1847       void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1848 
1849       if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, dynamic, &dynbuf))
1850 	return -1;
1851 
1852       extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1853       swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1854 
1855       extdyn = dynbuf;
1856       extdynend = extdyn + dynamic->size;
1857       for (; extdyn < extdynend; extdyn += extdynsize)
1858 	{
1859 	  Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1860 	  (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1861 
1862 	  if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1863 	    break;
1864 
1865 	  if (dyn.d_tag == DT_PPC_GOT)
1866 	    {
1867 	      unsigned int g_o_t = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1868 	      asection *got = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got");
1869 	      if (got != NULL
1870 		  && bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, got, buf,
1871 					       g_o_t - got->vma + 4, 4))
1872 		glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1873 	      break;
1874 	    }
1875 	}
1876       free (dynbuf);
1877     }
1878 
1879   /* Otherwise we read the first plt entry.  */
1880   if (glink_vma == 0)
1881     {
1882       if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, plt, buf, 0, 4))
1883 	glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1884     }
1885 
1886   if (glink_vma == 0)
1887     return 0;
1888 
1889   /* The .glink section usually does not survive the final
1890      link; search for the section (usually .text) where the
1891      glink stubs now reside.  */
1892   glink = bfd_sections_find_if (abfd, section_covers_vma, &glink_vma);
1893   if (glink == NULL)
1894     return 0;
1895 
1896   /* Determine glink PLT resolver by reading the relative branch
1897      from the first glink stub.  */
1898   if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1899 				glink_vma - glink->vma, 4))
1900     {
1901       unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1902 
1903       /* The first glink stub may either branch to the resolver ...  */
1904       insn ^= B;
1905       if ((insn & ~0x3fffffc) == 0)
1906 	resolv_vma = glink_vma + (insn ^ 0x2000000) - 0x2000000;
1907 
1908       /* ... or fall through a bunch of NOPs.  */
1909       else if ((insn ^ B ^ NOP) == 0)
1910 	for (i = 4;
1911 	     bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1912 				       glink_vma - glink->vma + i, 4);
1913 	     i += 4)
1914 	  if (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf) != NOP)
1915 	    {
1916 	      resolv_vma = glink_vma + i;
1917 	      break;
1918 	    }
1919     }
1920 
1921   count = relplt->size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
1922   /* If the stubs are those for -shared/-pie then we might have
1923      multiple stubs for each plt entry.  If that is the case then
1924      there is no way to associate stubs with their plt entries short
1925      of figuring out the GOT pointer value used in the stub.
1926      The offsets tested here need to cover all possible values of
1927      GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE for other than __tls_get_addr_opt.  */
1928   stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1929   for (stub_delta = 16; stub_delta <= 32; stub_delta += 8)
1930     if (is_nonpic_glink_stub (abfd, glink, stub_off - stub_delta))
1931       break;
1932   if (stub_delta > 32)
1933     return 0;
1934 
1935   slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
1936   if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, true))
1937     return -1;
1938 
1939   size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
1940   p = relplt->relocation;
1941   for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p++)
1942     {
1943       size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
1944       if (p->addend != 0)
1945 	size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
1946     }
1947 
1948   size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink");
1949 
1950   if (resolv_vma)
1951     size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
1952 
1953   s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
1954   if (s == NULL)
1955     return -1;
1956 
1957   stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1958   names = (char *) (s + count + 1 + (resolv_vma != 0));
1959   p = relplt->relocation + count - 1;
1960   for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
1961     {
1962       size_t len;
1963 
1964       stub_off -= stub_delta;
1965       if (strcmp ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, "__tls_get_addr_opt") == 0)
1966 	stub_off -= 32;
1967       *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
1968       /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set.  Since
1969 	 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set.  */
1970       if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
1971 	s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
1972       s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1973       s->section = glink;
1974       s->value = stub_off;
1975       s->name = names;
1976       s->udata.p = NULL;
1977       len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
1978       memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
1979       names += len;
1980       if (p->addend != 0)
1981 	{
1982 	  memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
1983 	  names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
1984 	  bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, names, p->addend);
1985 	  names += strlen (names);
1986 	}
1987       memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
1988       names += sizeof ("@plt");
1989       ++s;
1990       --p;
1991     }
1992 
1993   /* Add a symbol at the start of the glink branch table.  */
1994   memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
1995   s->the_bfd = abfd;
1996   s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1997   s->section = glink;
1998   s->value = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1999   s->name = names;
2000   memcpy (names, "__glink", sizeof ("__glink"));
2001   names += sizeof ("__glink");
2002   s++;
2003   count++;
2004 
2005   if (resolv_vma)
2006     {
2007       /* Add a symbol for the glink PLT resolver.  */
2008       memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
2009       s->the_bfd = abfd;
2010       s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
2011       s->section = glink;
2012       s->value = resolv_vma - glink->vma;
2013       s->name = names;
2014       memcpy (names, "__glink_PLTresolve", sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve"));
2015       names += sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
2016       s++;
2017       count++;
2018     }
2019 
2020   return count;
2021 }
2022 
2023 /* The following functions are specific to the ELF linker, while
2024    functions above are used generally.  They appear in this file more
2025    or less in the order in which they are called.  eg.
2026    ppc_elf_check_relocs is called early in the link process,
2027    ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections is one of the last functions
2028    called.  */
2029 
2030 /* Track PLT entries needed for a given symbol.  We might need more
2031    than one glink entry per symbol when generating a pic binary.  */
2032 struct plt_entry
2033 {
2034   struct plt_entry *next;
2035 
2036   /* -fPIC uses multiple GOT sections, one per file, called ".got2".
2037      This field stores the offset into .got2 used to initialise the
2038      GOT pointer reg.  It will always be at least 32768.  (Current
2039      gcc always uses an offset of 32768, but ld -r will pack .got2
2040      sections together resulting in larger offsets).  */
2041   bfd_vma addend;
2042 
2043   /* The .got2 section.  */
2044   asection *sec;
2045 
2046   /* PLT refcount or offset.  */
2047   union
2048     {
2049       bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2050       bfd_vma offset;
2051     } plt;
2052 
2053   /* .glink stub offset.  */
2054   bfd_vma glink_offset;
2055 };
2056 
2057 /* Of those relocs that might be copied as dynamic relocs, this
2058    function selects those that must be copied when linking a shared
2059    library or PIE, even when the symbol is local.  */
2060 
2061 static int
must_be_dyn_reloc(struct bfd_link_info * info,enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)2062 must_be_dyn_reloc (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2063 		   enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2064 {
2065   switch (r_type)
2066     {
2067     default:
2068       /* Only relative relocs can be resolved when the object load
2069 	 address isn't fixed.  DTPREL32 is excluded because the
2070 	 dynamic linker needs to differentiate global dynamic from
2071 	 local dynamic __tls_index pairs when PPC_OPT_TLS is set.  */
2072       return 1;
2073 
2074     case R_PPC_REL24:
2075     case R_PPC_REL14:
2076     case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
2077     case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
2078     case R_PPC_REL32:
2079       return 0;
2080 
2081     case R_PPC_TPREL32:
2082     case R_PPC_TPREL16:
2083     case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
2084     case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
2085     case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
2086       /* These relocations are relative but in a shared library the
2087 	 linker doesn't know the thread pointer base.  */
2088       return bfd_link_dll (info);
2089     }
2090 }
2091 
2092 /* If ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS is non-zero, the linker will try to avoid
2093    copying dynamic variables from a shared lib into an app's dynbss
2094    section, and instead use a dynamic relocation to point into the
2095    shared lib.  */
2096 #define ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 1
2097 
2098 /* Used to track dynamic relocations for local symbols.  */
2099 struct ppc_dyn_relocs
2100 {
2101   struct ppc_dyn_relocs *next;
2102 
2103   /* The input section of the reloc.  */
2104   asection *sec;
2105 
2106   /* Total number of relocs copied for the input section.  */
2107   unsigned int count : 31;
2108 
2109   /* Whether this entry is for STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols.  */
2110   unsigned int ifunc : 1;
2111 };
2112 
2113 /* PPC ELF linker hash entry.  */
2114 
2115 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry
2116 {
2117   struct elf_link_hash_entry elf;
2118 
2119   /* If this symbol is used in the linker created sections, the processor
2120      specific backend uses this field to map the field into the offset
2121      from the beginning of the section.  */
2122   elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_pointer;
2123 
2124   /* Contexts in which symbol is used in the GOT.
2125      Bits are or'd into the mask as the corresponding relocs are
2126      encountered during check_relocs, with TLS_TLS being set when any
2127      of the other TLS bits are set.  tls_optimize clears bits when
2128      optimizing to indicate the corresponding GOT entry type is not
2129      needed.  If set, TLS_TLS is never cleared.  tls_optimize may also
2130      set TLS_GDIE when a GD reloc turns into an IE one.
2131      These flags are also kept for local symbols.  */
2132 #define TLS_TLS		 1	/* Any TLS reloc.  */
2133 #define TLS_GD		 2	/* GD reloc. */
2134 #define TLS_LD		 4	/* LD reloc. */
2135 #define TLS_TPREL	 8	/* TPREL reloc, => IE. */
2136 #define TLS_DTPREL	16	/* DTPREL reloc, => LD. */
2137 #define TLS_MARK	32	/* __tls_get_addr call marked. */
2138 #define TLS_GDIE	64	/* GOT TPREL reloc resulting from GD->IE. */
2139   unsigned char tls_mask;
2140 
2141   /* The above field is also used to mark function symbols.  In which
2142      case TLS_TLS will be 0.  */
2143 #define PLT_IFUNC	 2	/* STT_GNU_IFUNC.  */
2144 #define PLT_KEEP	 4	/* inline plt call requires plt entry.  */
2145 #define NON_GOT        256	/* local symbol plt, not stored.  */
2146 
2147   /* Nonzero if we have seen a small data relocation referring to this
2148      symbol.  */
2149   unsigned char has_sda_refs : 1;
2150 
2151   /* Flag use of given relocations.  */
2152   unsigned char has_addr16_ha : 1;
2153   unsigned char has_addr16_lo : 1;
2154 };
2155 
2156 #define ppc_elf_hash_entry(ent) ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) (ent))
2157 
2158 /* PPC ELF linker hash table.  */
2159 
2160 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table
2161 {
2162   struct elf_link_hash_table elf;
2163 
2164   /* Various options passed from the linker.  */
2165   struct ppc_elf_params *params;
2166 
2167   /* Short-cuts to get to dynamic linker sections.  */
2168   asection *glink;
2169   asection *dynsbss;
2170   asection *relsbss;
2171   elf_linker_section_t sdata[2];
2172   asection *sbss;
2173   asection *glink_eh_frame;
2174   asection *pltlocal;
2175   asection *relpltlocal;
2176 
2177   /* The (unloaded but important) .rela.plt.unloaded on VxWorks.  */
2178   asection *srelplt2;
2179 
2180   /* Shortcut to __tls_get_addr.  */
2181   struct elf_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr;
2182 
2183   /* The bfd that forced an old-style PLT.  */
2184   bfd *old_bfd;
2185 
2186   /* TLS local dynamic got entry handling.  */
2187   union {
2188     bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2189     bfd_vma offset;
2190   } tlsld_got;
2191 
2192   /* Offset of branch table to PltResolve function in glink.  */
2193   bfd_vma glink_pltresolve;
2194 
2195   /* Size of reserved GOT entries.  */
2196   unsigned int got_header_size;
2197   /* Non-zero if allocating the header left a gap.  */
2198   unsigned int got_gap;
2199 
2200   /* The type of PLT we have chosen to use.  */
2201   enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type;
2202 
2203   /* Whether there exist local gnu indirect function resolvers,
2204      referenced by dynamic relocations.  */
2205   unsigned int local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2206   unsigned int maybe_local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2207 
2208   /* Set if tls optimization is enabled.  */
2209   unsigned int do_tls_opt:1;
2210 
2211   /* Set if inline plt calls should be converted to direct calls.  */
2212   unsigned int can_convert_all_inline_plt:1;
2213 
2214   /* The size of PLT entries.  */
2215   int plt_entry_size;
2216   /* The distance between adjacent PLT slots.  */
2217   int plt_slot_size;
2218   /* The size of the first PLT entry.  */
2219   int plt_initial_entry_size;
2220 };
2221 
2222 /* Rename some of the generic section flags to better document how they
2223    are used for ppc32.  The flags are only valid for ppc32 elf objects.  */
2224 
2225 /* Nonzero if this section has TLS related relocations.  */
2226 #define has_tls_reloc sec_flg0
2227 
2228 /* Nonzero if this section has a call to __tls_get_addr lacking marker
2229    relocs.  */
2230 #define nomark_tls_get_addr sec_flg1
2231 
2232   /* Flag set when PLTCALL relocs are detected.  */
2233 #define has_pltcall sec_flg2
2234 
2235 /* Get the PPC ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure.  */
2236 
2237 #define ppc_elf_hash_table(p) \
2238   ((is_elf_hash_table ((p)->hash)					\
2239     && elf_hash_table_id (elf_hash_table (p)) == PPC32_ELF_DATA)	\
2240    ? (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *) (p)->hash : NULL)
2241 
2242 /* Create an entry in a PPC ELF linker hash table.  */
2243 
2244 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc(struct bfd_hash_entry * entry,struct bfd_hash_table * table,const char * string)2245 ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
2246 			   struct bfd_hash_table *table,
2247 			   const char *string)
2248 {
2249   /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
2250      subclass.  */
2251   if (entry == NULL)
2252     {
2253       entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table,
2254 				 sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry));
2255       if (entry == NULL)
2256 	return entry;
2257     }
2258 
2259   /* Call the allocation method of the superclass.  */
2260   entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
2261   if (entry != NULL)
2262     {
2263       ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->linker_section_pointer = NULL;
2264       ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->tls_mask = 0;
2265       ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->has_sda_refs = 0;
2266     }
2267 
2268   return entry;
2269 }
2270 
2271 /* Create a PPC ELF linker hash table.  */
2272 
2273 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create(bfd * abfd)2274 ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
2275 {
2276   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
2277   static struct ppc_elf_params default_params
2278     = { PLT_OLD, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 12, 0, 0, 0 };
2279 
2280   ret = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table));
2281   if (ret == NULL)
2282     return NULL;
2283 
2284   if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->elf, abfd,
2285 				      ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
2286 				      sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry),
2287 				      PPC32_ELF_DATA))
2288     {
2289       free (ret);
2290       return NULL;
2291     }
2292 
2293   ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.refcount = 0;
2294   ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.glist = NULL;
2295   ret->elf.init_plt_offset.offset = 0;
2296   ret->elf.init_plt_offset.glist = NULL;
2297 
2298   ret->params = &default_params;
2299 
2300   ret->sdata[0].name = ".sdata";
2301   ret->sdata[0].sym_name = "_SDA_BASE_";
2302   ret->sdata[0].bss_name = ".sbss";
2303 
2304   ret->sdata[1].name = ".sdata2";
2305   ret->sdata[1].sym_name = "_SDA2_BASE_";
2306   ret->sdata[1].bss_name = ".sbss2";
2307 
2308   ret->plt_entry_size = 12;
2309   ret->plt_slot_size = 8;
2310   ret->plt_initial_entry_size = 72;
2311 
2312   return &ret->elf.root;
2313 }
2314 
2315 /* Hook linker params into hash table.  */
2316 
2317 void
ppc_elf_link_params(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct ppc_elf_params * params)2318 ppc_elf_link_params (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct ppc_elf_params *params)
2319 {
2320   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2321 
2322   if (htab)
2323     htab->params = params;
2324   params->pagesize_p2 = bfd_log2 (params->pagesize);
2325 }
2326 
2327 /* Create .got and the related sections.  */
2328 
2329 static bool
ppc_elf_create_got(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)2330 ppc_elf_create_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2331 {
2332   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2333 
2334   if (!_bfd_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info))
2335     return false;
2336 
2337   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2338   if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks)
2339     {
2340       /* The powerpc .got has a blrl instruction in it.  Mark it
2341 	 executable.  */
2342       flagword flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2343 			| SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2344       if (!bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags))
2345 	return false;
2346     }
2347 
2348   return true;
2349 }
2350 
2351 /* Create a special linker section, used for R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16 and
2352    R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16 pointers.  These sections become part of .sdata
2353    and .sdata2.  Create _SDA_BASE_ and _SDA2_BASE too.  */
2354 
2355 static bool
ppc_elf_create_linker_section(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,flagword flags,elf_linker_section_t * lsect)2356 ppc_elf_create_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2357 			       struct bfd_link_info *info,
2358 			       flagword flags,
2359 			       elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2360 {
2361   asection *s;
2362 
2363   flags |= (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
2364 	    | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2365 
2366   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, lsect->name, flags);
2367   if (s == NULL)
2368     return false;
2369   lsect->section = s;
2370 
2371   /* Define the sym on the first section of this name.  */
2372   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, lsect->name);
2373 
2374   lsect->sym = _bfd_elf_define_linkage_sym (abfd, info, s, lsect->sym_name);
2375   if (lsect->sym == NULL)
2376     return false;
2377   lsect->sym->root.u.def.value = 0x8000;
2378   return true;
2379 }
2380 
2381 static bool
ppc_elf_create_glink(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)2382 ppc_elf_create_glink (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2383 {
2384   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2385   asection *s;
2386   flagword flags;
2387   int p2align;
2388 
2389   flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2390 	   | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2391   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".glink", flags);
2392   htab->glink = s;
2393   p2align = htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 6 : 4;
2394   if (p2align < htab->params->plt_stub_align)
2395     p2align = htab->params->plt_stub_align;
2396   if (s == NULL
2397       || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, p2align))
2398     return false;
2399 
2400   if (!info->no_ld_generated_unwind_info)
2401     {
2402       flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2403 	       | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2404       s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".eh_frame", flags);
2405       htab->glink_eh_frame = s;
2406       if (s == NULL
2407 	  || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2408 	return false;
2409     }
2410 
2411   flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2412   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".iplt", flags);
2413   htab->elf.iplt = s;
2414   if (s == NULL
2415       || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 4))
2416     return false;
2417 
2418   flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2419 	   | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2420   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.iplt", flags);
2421   htab->elf.irelplt = s;
2422   if (s == NULL
2423       || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2424     return false;
2425 
2426   /* Local plt entries.  */
2427   flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
2428 	   | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2429   htab->pltlocal = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".branch_lt",
2430 						       flags);
2431   if (htab->pltlocal == NULL
2432       || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->pltlocal, 2))
2433     return false;
2434 
2435   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
2436     {
2437       flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
2438 	       | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2439       htab->relpltlocal
2440 	= bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
2441       if (htab->relpltlocal == NULL
2442 	  || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->relpltlocal, 2))
2443 	return false;
2444     }
2445 
2446   if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, 0,
2447 				      &htab->sdata[0]))
2448     return false;
2449 
2450   if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, SEC_READONLY,
2451 				      &htab->sdata[1]))
2452     return false;
2453 
2454   return true;
2455 }
2456 
2457 /* We have to create .dynsbss and .rela.sbss here so that they get mapped
2458    to output sections (just like _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections has
2459    to create .dynbss and .rela.bss).  */
2460 
2461 static bool
ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)2462 ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2463 {
2464   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2465   asection *s;
2466   flagword flags;
2467 
2468   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2469 
2470   if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2471       && !ppc_elf_create_got (abfd, info))
2472     return false;
2473 
2474   if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
2475     return false;
2476 
2477   if (htab->glink == NULL
2478       && !ppc_elf_create_glink (abfd, info))
2479     return false;
2480 
2481   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".dynsbss",
2482 					  SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2483   htab->dynsbss = s;
2484   if (s == NULL)
2485     return false;
2486 
2487   if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
2488     {
2489       flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2490 	       | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2491       s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.sbss", flags);
2492       htab->relsbss = s;
2493       if (s == NULL
2494 	  || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2495 	return false;
2496     }
2497 
2498   if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
2499       && !elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2))
2500     return false;
2501 
2502   s = htab->elf.splt;
2503   flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2504   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
2505     /* The VxWorks PLT is a loaded section with contents.  */
2506     flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY;
2507   return bfd_set_section_flags (s, flags);
2508 }
2509 
2510 /* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry.  */
2511 
2512 static void
ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * dir,struct elf_link_hash_entry * ind)2513 ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2514 			      struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
2515 			      struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
2516 {
2517   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
2518 
2519   edir = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
2520   eind = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
2521 
2522   edir->tls_mask |= eind->tls_mask;
2523   edir->has_sda_refs |= eind->has_sda_refs;
2524 
2525   if (edir->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden)
2526     edir->elf.ref_dynamic |= eind->elf.ref_dynamic;
2527   edir->elf.ref_regular |= eind->elf.ref_regular;
2528   edir->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eind->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
2529   edir->elf.non_got_ref |= eind->elf.non_got_ref;
2530   edir->elf.needs_plt |= eind->elf.needs_plt;
2531   edir->elf.pointer_equality_needed |= eind->elf.pointer_equality_needed;
2532 
2533   /* If we were called to copy over info for a weak sym, that's all.  */
2534   if (eind->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
2535     return;
2536 
2537   if (ind->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2538     {
2539       if (dir->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2540 	{
2541 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
2542 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
2543 
2544 	  /* Add reloc counts against the indirect sym to the direct sym
2545 	     list.  Merge any entries against the same section.  */
2546 	  for (pp = &ind->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
2547 	    {
2548 	      struct elf_dyn_relocs *q;
2549 
2550 	      for (q = dir->dyn_relocs; q != NULL; q = q->next)
2551 		if (q->sec == p->sec)
2552 		  {
2553 		    q->pc_count += p->pc_count;
2554 		    q->count += p->count;
2555 		    *pp = p->next;
2556 		    break;
2557 		  }
2558 	      if (q == NULL)
2559 		pp = &p->next;
2560 	    }
2561 	  *pp = dir->dyn_relocs;
2562 	}
2563 
2564       dir->dyn_relocs = ind->dyn_relocs;
2565       ind->dyn_relocs = NULL;
2566     }
2567 
2568   /* Copy over the GOT refcount entries that we may have already seen to
2569      the symbol which just became indirect.  */
2570   edir->elf.got.refcount += eind->elf.got.refcount;
2571   eind->elf.got.refcount = 0;
2572 
2573   /* And plt entries.  */
2574   if (eind->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2575     {
2576       if (edir->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2577 	{
2578 	  struct plt_entry **entp;
2579 	  struct plt_entry *ent;
2580 
2581 	  for (entp = &eind->elf.plt.plist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
2582 	    {
2583 	      struct plt_entry *dent;
2584 
2585 	      for (dent = edir->elf.plt.plist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
2586 		if (dent->sec == ent->sec && dent->addend == ent->addend)
2587 		  {
2588 		    dent->plt.refcount += ent->plt.refcount;
2589 		    *entp = ent->next;
2590 		    break;
2591 		  }
2592 	      if (dent == NULL)
2593 		entp = &ent->next;
2594 	    }
2595 	  *entp = edir->elf.plt.plist;
2596 	}
2597 
2598       edir->elf.plt.plist = eind->elf.plt.plist;
2599       eind->elf.plt.plist = NULL;
2600     }
2601 
2602   if (eind->elf.dynindx != -1)
2603     {
2604       if (edir->elf.dynindx != -1)
2605 	_bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
2606 				edir->elf.dynstr_index);
2607       edir->elf.dynindx = eind->elf.dynindx;
2608       edir->elf.dynstr_index = eind->elf.dynstr_index;
2609       eind->elf.dynindx = -1;
2610       eind->elf.dynstr_index = 0;
2611     }
2612 }
2613 
2614 /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
2615    file.  We use it to put .comm items in .sbss, and not .bss.  */
2616 
2617 static bool
ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym,const char ** namep ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,flagword * flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection ** secp,bfd_vma * valp)2618 ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
2619 			 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2620 			 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
2621 			 const char **namep ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2622 			 flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2623 			 asection **secp,
2624 			 bfd_vma *valp)
2625 {
2626   if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
2627       && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
2628       && is_ppc_elf (info->output_bfd)
2629       && sym->st_size <= elf_gp_size (abfd))
2630     {
2631       /* Common symbols less than or equal to -G nn bytes are automatically
2632 	 put into .sbss.  */
2633       struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2634 
2635       htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2636       if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2637 	{
2638 	  flagword flags = SEC_IS_COMMON | SEC_SMALL_DATA | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2639 
2640 	  if (!htab->elf.dynobj)
2641 	    htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2642 
2643 	  htab->sbss = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (htab->elf.dynobj,
2644 							   ".sbss",
2645 							   flags);
2646 	  if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2647 	    return false;
2648 	}
2649 
2650       *secp = htab->sbss;
2651       *valp = sym->st_size;
2652     }
2653 
2654   return true;
2655 }
2656 
2657 /* Find a linker generated pointer with a given addend and type.  */
2658 
2659 static elf_linker_section_pointers_t *
elf_find_pointer_linker_section(elf_linker_section_pointers_t * linker_pointers,bfd_vma addend,elf_linker_section_t * lsect)2660 elf_find_pointer_linker_section
2661   (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_pointers,
2662    bfd_vma addend,
2663    elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2664 {
2665   for ( ; linker_pointers != NULL; linker_pointers = linker_pointers->next)
2666     if (lsect == linker_pointers->lsect && addend == linker_pointers->addend)
2667       return linker_pointers;
2668 
2669   return NULL;
2670 }
2671 
2672 /* Allocate a pointer to live in a linker created section.  */
2673 
2674 static bool
elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section(bfd * abfd,elf_linker_section_t * lsect,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,const Elf_Internal_Rela * rel)2675 elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2676 				     elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
2677 				     struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2678 				     const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
2679 {
2680   elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr_linker_section_ptr = NULL;
2681   elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
2682   unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2683   bfd_size_type amt;
2684 
2685   BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
2686 
2687   /* Is this a global symbol?  */
2688   if (h != NULL)
2689     {
2690       struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
2691 
2692       /* Has this symbol already been allocated?  If so, our work is done.  */
2693       eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2694       if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (eh->linker_section_pointer,
2695 					   rel->r_addend,
2696 					   lsect))
2697 	return true;
2698 
2699       ptr_linker_section_ptr = &eh->linker_section_pointer;
2700     }
2701   else
2702     {
2703       BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2704 
2705       /* Allocation of a pointer to a local symbol.  */
2706       elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd);
2707 
2708       /* Allocate a table to hold the local symbols if first time.  */
2709       if (!ptr)
2710 	{
2711 	  unsigned int num_symbols = elf_symtab_hdr (abfd).sh_info;
2712 
2713 	  amt = num_symbols;
2714 	  amt *= sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *);
2715 	  ptr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
2716 
2717 	  if (!ptr)
2718 	    return false;
2719 
2720 	  elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd) = ptr;
2721 	}
2722 
2723       /* Has this symbol already been allocated?  If so, our work is done.  */
2724       if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (ptr[r_symndx],
2725 					   rel->r_addend,
2726 					   lsect))
2727 	return true;
2728 
2729       ptr_linker_section_ptr = &ptr[r_symndx];
2730     }
2731 
2732   /* Allocate space for a pointer in the linker section, and allocate
2733      a new pointer record from internal memory.  */
2734   BFD_ASSERT (ptr_linker_section_ptr != NULL);
2735   amt = sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t);
2736   linker_section_ptr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2737 
2738   if (!linker_section_ptr)
2739     return false;
2740 
2741   linker_section_ptr->next = *ptr_linker_section_ptr;
2742   linker_section_ptr->addend = rel->r_addend;
2743   linker_section_ptr->lsect = lsect;
2744   *ptr_linker_section_ptr = linker_section_ptr;
2745 
2746   if (!bfd_set_section_alignment (lsect->section, 2))
2747     return false;
2748   linker_section_ptr->offset = lsect->section->size;
2749   lsect->section->size += 4;
2750 
2751 #ifdef DEBUG
2752   fprintf (stderr,
2753 	   "Create pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld, section size = %ld\n",
2754 	   lsect->name, (long) linker_section_ptr->offset,
2755 	   (long) lsect->section->size);
2756 #endif
2757 
2758   return true;
2759 }
2760 
2761 static struct plt_entry **
update_local_sym_info(bfd * abfd,Elf_Internal_Shdr * symtab_hdr,unsigned long r_symndx,int tls_type)2762 update_local_sym_info (bfd *abfd,
2763 		       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
2764 		       unsigned long r_symndx,
2765 		       int tls_type)
2766 {
2767   bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
2768   struct plt_entry **local_plt;
2769   unsigned char *local_got_tls_masks;
2770 
2771   if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2772     {
2773       bfd_size_type size = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
2774 
2775       size *= (sizeof (*local_got_refcounts)
2776 	       + sizeof (*local_plt)
2777 	       + sizeof (*local_got_tls_masks));
2778       local_got_refcounts = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
2779       if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2780 	return NULL;
2781       elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) = local_got_refcounts;
2782     }
2783 
2784   local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_refcounts + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2785   local_got_tls_masks = (unsigned char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2786   local_got_tls_masks[r_symndx] |= tls_type & 0xff;
2787   if ((tls_type & NON_GOT) == 0)
2788     local_got_refcounts[r_symndx] += 1;
2789   return local_plt + r_symndx;
2790 }
2791 
2792 static bool
update_plt_info(bfd * abfd,struct plt_entry ** plist,asection * sec,bfd_vma addend)2793 update_plt_info (bfd *abfd, struct plt_entry **plist,
2794 		 asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2795 {
2796   struct plt_entry *ent;
2797 
2798   if (addend < 32768)
2799     sec = NULL;
2800   for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2801     if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2802       break;
2803   if (ent == NULL)
2804     {
2805       size_t amt = sizeof (*ent);
2806       ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2807       if (ent == NULL)
2808 	return false;
2809       ent->next = *plist;
2810       ent->sec = sec;
2811       ent->addend = addend;
2812       ent->plt.refcount = 0;
2813       *plist = ent;
2814     }
2815   ent->plt.refcount += 1;
2816   return true;
2817 }
2818 
2819 static struct plt_entry *
find_plt_ent(struct plt_entry ** plist,asection * sec,bfd_vma addend)2820 find_plt_ent (struct plt_entry **plist, asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2821 {
2822   struct plt_entry *ent;
2823 
2824   if (addend < 32768)
2825     sec = NULL;
2826   for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2827     if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2828       break;
2829   return ent;
2830 }
2831 
2832 static bool
is_branch_reloc(enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)2833 is_branch_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2834 {
2835   return (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
2836 	  || r_type == R_PPC_LOCAL24PC
2837 	  || r_type == R_PPC_REL24
2838 	  || r_type == R_PPC_REL14
2839 	  || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
2840 	  || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN
2841 	  || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR24
2842 	  || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14
2843 	  || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
2844 	  || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
2845 	  || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_REL24);
2846 }
2847 
2848 /* Relocs on inline plt call sequence insns prior to the call.  */
2849 
2850 static bool
is_plt_seq_reloc(enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)2851 is_plt_seq_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2852 {
2853   return (r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA
2854 	  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2855 	  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2856 	  || r_type == R_PPC_PLTSEQ);
2857 }
2858 
2859 /* Like bfd_reloc_offset_in_range but without a howto.  Return true
2860    iff a field of SIZE bytes at OFFSET is within SEC limits.  */
2861 
2862 static bool
offset_in_range(asection * sec,bfd_vma offset,size_t size)2863 offset_in_range (asection *sec, bfd_vma offset, size_t size)
2864 {
2865   return offset <= sec->size && size <= sec->size - offset;
2866 }
2867 
2868 static void
bad_shared_reloc(bfd * abfd,enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)2869 bad_shared_reloc (bfd *abfd, enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2870 {
2871   _bfd_error_handler
2872     /* xgettext:c-format */
2873     (_("%pB: relocation %s cannot be used when making a shared object"),
2874      abfd,
2875      ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
2876   bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2877 }
2878 
2879 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
2880    allocate space in the global offset table or procedure linkage
2881    table.  */
2882 
2883 static bool
ppc_elf_check_relocs(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,asection * sec,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocs)2884 ppc_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd,
2885 		      struct bfd_link_info *info,
2886 		      asection *sec,
2887 		      const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
2888 {
2889   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2890   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2891   struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
2892   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
2893   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
2894   asection *got2, *sreloc;
2895   struct elf_link_hash_entry *tga;
2896 
2897   if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
2898     return true;
2899 
2900 #ifdef DEBUG
2901   _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_check_relocs called for section %pA in %pB",
2902 		      sec, abfd);
2903 #endif
2904 
2905   BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2906 
2907   /* Initialize howto table if not already done.  */
2908   if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
2909     ppc_elf_howto_init ();
2910 
2911   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2912   if (htab->glink == NULL)
2913     {
2914       if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2915 	htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2916       if (!ppc_elf_create_glink (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2917 	return false;
2918     }
2919   tga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
2920 			      false, false, true);
2921   symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
2922   sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
2923   got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
2924   sreloc = NULL;
2925 
2926   rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
2927   for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
2928     {
2929       unsigned long r_symndx;
2930       enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
2931       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
2932       Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
2933       int tls_type;
2934       struct plt_entry **ifunc;
2935       struct plt_entry **pltent;
2936       bfd_vma addend;
2937 
2938       r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2939       if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
2940 	{
2941 	  h = NULL;
2942 	  isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->elf.sym_cache, abfd, r_symndx);
2943 	  if (isym == NULL)
2944 	    return false;
2945 	}
2946       else
2947 	{
2948 	  h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
2949 	  while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
2950 		 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2951 	    h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
2952 	  isym = NULL;
2953 	}
2954 
2955       /* If a relocation refers to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_, create the .got.
2956 	 This shows up in particular in an R_PPC_ADDR32 in the eabi
2957 	 startup code.  */
2958       if (h != NULL
2959 	  && htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2960 	  && strcmp (h->root.root.string, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_") == 0)
2961 	{
2962 	  if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2963 	    htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2964 	  if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2965 	    return false;
2966 	  BFD_ASSERT (h == htab->elf.hgot);
2967 	}
2968 
2969       tls_type = 0;
2970       r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
2971       ifunc = NULL;
2972       if (h != NULL)
2973 	{
2974 	  if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
2975 	    {
2976 	      h->needs_plt = 1;
2977 	      ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
2978 	    }
2979 	}
2980       else if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks)
2981 	{
2982 	  if (ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
2983 	    {
2984 	      /* Set PLT_IFUNC flag for this sym, no GOT entry yet.  */
2985 	      ifunc = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
2986 					     NON_GOT | PLT_IFUNC);
2987 	      if (ifunc == NULL)
2988 		return false;
2989 
2990 	      /* STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols must have a PLT entry;
2991 		 In a non-pie executable even when there are
2992 		 no plt calls.  */
2993 	      if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
2994 		  || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
2995 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2996 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2997 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA)
2998 		{
2999 		  addend = 0;
3000 		  if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
3001 		    ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
3002 		  if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3003 		      && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
3004 			  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
3005 			  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
3006 			  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
3007 		    addend = rel->r_addend;
3008 		  if (!update_plt_info (abfd, ifunc, got2, addend))
3009 		    return false;
3010 		}
3011 	    }
3012 	}
3013 
3014       if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks
3015 	  && is_branch_reloc (r_type)
3016 	  && h != NULL
3017 	  && h == tga)
3018 	{
3019 	  if (rel != relocs
3020 	      && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSGD
3021 		  || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSLD))
3022 	    /* We have a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a marker
3023 	       reloc.  */
3024 	    ;
3025 	  else
3026 	    /* Mark this section as having an old-style call.  */
3027 	    sec->nomark_tls_get_addr = 1;
3028 	}
3029 
3030       switch (r_type)
3031 	{
3032 	case R_PPC_TLSGD:
3033 	case R_PPC_TLSLD:
3034 	  /* These special tls relocs tie a call to __tls_get_addr with
3035 	     its parameter symbol.  */
3036 	  if (h != NULL)
3037 	    ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK;
3038 	  else
3039 	    if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3040 					NON_GOT | TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
3041 	      return false;
3042 	  break;
3043 
3044 	case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
3045 	  break;
3046 
3047 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
3048 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
3049 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
3050 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
3051 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
3052 	  goto dogottls;
3053 
3054 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
3055 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
3056 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
3057 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
3058 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
3059 	  goto dogottls;
3060 
3061 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
3062 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
3063 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
3064 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
3065 	  if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3066 	    info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3067 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
3068 	  goto dogottls;
3069 
3070 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
3071 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
3072 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
3073 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
3074 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
3075 	dogottls:
3076 	  sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
3077 	  /* Fall through.  */
3078 
3079 	  /* GOT16 relocations */
3080 	case R_PPC_GOT16:
3081 	case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
3082 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
3083 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
3084 	  /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry.  */
3085 	  if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
3086 	    {
3087 	      if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3088 		htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3089 	      if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
3090 		return false;
3091 	    }
3092 	  if (h != NULL)
3093 	    {
3094 	      h->got.refcount += 1;
3095 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= tls_type;
3096 	    }
3097 	  else
3098 	    /* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol.  */
3099 	    if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx, tls_type))
3100 	      return false;
3101 
3102 	  /* We may also need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3103 	     an ifunc.  */
3104 	  if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3105 	    {
3106 	      if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3107 		return false;
3108 	    }
3109 	  break;
3110 
3111 	  /* Indirect .sdata relocation.  */
3112 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
3113 	  htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3114 	  if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[0],
3115 						    h, rel))
3116 	    return false;
3117 	  if (h != NULL)
3118 	    {
3119 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
3120 	      h->non_got_ref = true;
3121 	    }
3122 	  break;
3123 
3124 	  /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation.  */
3125 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
3126 	  if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
3127 	    {
3128 	      bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3129 	      return false;
3130 	    }
3131 	  htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3132 	  if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[1],
3133 						    h, rel))
3134 	    return false;
3135 	  if (h != NULL)
3136 	    {
3137 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
3138 	      h->non_got_ref = true;
3139 	    }
3140 	  break;
3141 
3142 	case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
3143 	  htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3144 	  /* Fall through.  */
3145 
3146 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
3147 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
3148 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
3149 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
3150 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
3151 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
3152 	  if (h != NULL)
3153 	    {
3154 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
3155 	      h->non_got_ref = true;
3156 	    }
3157 	  break;
3158 
3159 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
3160 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
3161 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
3162 	case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
3163 	case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
3164 	case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
3165 	case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
3166 	case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
3167 	case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
3168 	case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
3169 	  break;
3170 
3171 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
3172 	  if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
3173 	    {
3174 	      bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3175 	      return false;
3176 	    }
3177 	  htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3178 	  if (h != NULL)
3179 	    {
3180 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
3181 	      h->non_got_ref = true;
3182 	    }
3183 	  break;
3184 
3185 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
3186 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
3187 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
3188 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
3189 	  if (h != NULL)
3190 	    {
3191 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
3192 	      h->non_got_ref = true;
3193 	    }
3194 	  break;
3195 
3196 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
3197 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
3198 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
3199 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
3200 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
3201 	  if (h != NULL)
3202 	    h->non_got_ref = true;
3203 	  break;
3204 
3205 	case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
3206 	  if (h == NULL)
3207 	    break;
3208 	  ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
3209 	  goto pltentry;
3210 
3211 	case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
3212 	  sec->has_pltcall = 1;
3213 	  /* Fall through.  */
3214 
3215 	case R_PPC_PLT32:
3216 	case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
3217 	case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
3218 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
3219 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
3220 	pltentry:
3221 #ifdef DEBUG
3222 	  fprintf (stderr, "Reloc requires a PLT entry\n");
3223 #endif
3224 	  /* This symbol requires a procedure linkage table entry.  */
3225 	  if (h == NULL)
3226 	    {
3227 	      pltent = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3228 					      NON_GOT | PLT_KEEP);
3229 	      if (pltent == NULL)
3230 		return false;
3231 	    }
3232 	  else
3233 	    {
3234 	      if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
3235 		ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= PLT_KEEP;
3236 	      h->needs_plt = 1;
3237 	      pltent = &h->plt.plist;
3238 	    }
3239 	  addend = 0;
3240 	  if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3241 	      && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
3242 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
3243 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
3244 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
3245 	    addend = rel->r_addend;
3246 	  if (!update_plt_info (abfd, pltent, got2, addend))
3247 	    return false;
3248 	  break;
3249 
3250 	  /* The following relocations don't need to propagate the
3251 	     relocation if linking a shared object since they are
3252 	     section relative.  */
3253 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
3254 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
3255 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
3256 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
3257 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
3258 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
3259 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
3260 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
3261 	case R_PPC_TOC16:
3262 	  break;
3263 
3264 	case R_PPC_REL16:
3265 	case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
3266 	case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
3267 	case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
3268 	case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
3269 	  ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_rel16 = 1;
3270 	  break;
3271 
3272 	  /* These are just markers.  */
3273 	case R_PPC_TLS:
3274 	case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
3275 	case R_PPC_NONE:
3276 	case R_PPC_max:
3277 	case R_PPC_RELAX:
3278 	case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
3279 	case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
3280 	case R_PPC_16DX_HA:
3281 	  break;
3282 
3283 	  /* These should only appear in dynamic objects.  */
3284 	case R_PPC_COPY:
3285 	case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
3286 	case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
3287 	case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
3288 	case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
3289 	  break;
3290 
3291 	  /* These aren't handled yet.  We'll report an error later.  */
3292 	case R_PPC_ADDR30:
3293 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
3294 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
3295 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
3296 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
3297 	case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
3298 	  break;
3299 
3300 	  /* This refers only to functions defined in the shared library.  */
3301 	case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
3302 	  if (h != NULL && h == htab->elf.hgot && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3303 	    {
3304 	      htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3305 	      htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3306 	    }
3307 	  if (h != NULL
3308 	      && ifunc != NULL
3309 	      && !update_plt_info (abfd, ifunc, NULL, 0))
3310 	    return false;
3311 	  break;
3312 
3313 	  /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
3314 	     Reconstruct it for later use during GC.  */
3315 	case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
3316 	  if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
3317 	    return false;
3318 	  break;
3319 
3320 	  /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
3321 	     used.  Record for later use during GC.  */
3322 	case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
3323 	  if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend))
3324 	    return false;
3325 	  break;
3326 
3327 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
3328 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
3329 	  sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
3330 	  /* Fall through.  */
3331 	  /* We shouldn't really be seeing TPREL32.  */
3332 	case R_PPC_TPREL32:
3333 	case R_PPC_TPREL16:
3334 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
3335 	  if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3336 	    info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3337 	  goto dodyn;
3338 
3339 	  /* Nor these.  */
3340 	case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
3341 	case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
3342 	  goto dodyn;
3343 
3344 	case R_PPC_REL32:
3345 	  if (h == NULL
3346 	      && got2 != NULL
3347 	      && (sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
3348 	      && bfd_link_pic (info)
3349 	      && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3350 	    {
3351 	      /* Old -fPIC gcc code has .long LCTOC1-LCFx just before
3352 		 the start of a function, which assembles to a REL32
3353 		 reference to .got2.  If we detect one of these, then
3354 		 force the old PLT layout because the linker cannot
3355 		 reliably deduce the GOT pointer value needed for
3356 		 PLT call stubs.  */
3357 	      asection *s;
3358 
3359 	      s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3360 	      if (s == got2)
3361 		{
3362 		  htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3363 		  htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3364 		}
3365 	    }
3366 	  if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
3367 	    break;
3368 	  /* fall through */
3369 
3370 	case R_PPC_ADDR32:
3371 	case R_PPC_ADDR16:
3372 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
3373 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
3374 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
3375 	case R_PPC_UADDR32:
3376 	case R_PPC_UADDR16:
3377 	  if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3378 	    {
3379 	      /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3380 		 a function defined in a dynamic object.  */
3381 	      if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3382 		return false;
3383 
3384 	      /* We may need a copy reloc too.  */
3385 	      h->non_got_ref = 1;
3386 	      h->pointer_equality_needed = 1;
3387 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
3388 		ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha = 1;
3389 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
3390 		ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo = 1;
3391 	    }
3392 	  goto dodyn;
3393 
3394 	case R_PPC_REL24:
3395 	case R_PPC_REL14:
3396 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
3397 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
3398 	  if (h == NULL)
3399 	    break;
3400 	  if (h == htab->elf.hgot)
3401 	    {
3402 	      if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3403 		{
3404 		  htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3405 		  htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3406 		}
3407 	      break;
3408 	    }
3409 	  /* fall through */
3410 
3411 	case R_PPC_ADDR24:
3412 	case R_PPC_ADDR14:
3413 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
3414 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
3415 	  if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3416 	    {
3417 	      /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3418 		 a function defined in a dynamic object.  */
3419 	      h->needs_plt = 1;
3420 	      if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3421 		return false;
3422 	      break;
3423 	    }
3424 
3425 	dodyn:
3426 	  /* Set up information for symbols that might need dynamic
3427 	     relocations.  At this point in linking we have read all
3428 	     the input files and resolved most symbols, but have not
3429 	     yet decided whether symbols are dynamic or finalized
3430 	     symbol flags.  In some cases we might be setting dynamic
3431 	     reloc info for symbols that do not end up needing such.
3432 	     That's OK, adjust_dynamic_symbol and allocate_dynrelocs
3433 	     work together with this code.  */
3434 	  if ((h != NULL
3435 	       && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
3436 	      || (bfd_link_pic (info)
3437 		  && (h != NULL
3438 		      ? !bfd_is_abs_symbol (&h->root)
3439 		      : isym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)
3440 		  && must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
3441 	    {
3442 #ifdef DEBUG
3443 	      fprintf (stderr,
3444 		       "ppc_elf_check_relocs needs to "
3445 		       "create relocation for %s\n",
3446 		       (h && h->root.root.string
3447 			? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
3448 #endif
3449 	      if (sreloc == NULL)
3450 		{
3451 		  if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3452 		    htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3453 
3454 		  sreloc = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_reloc_section
3455 		    (sec, htab->elf.dynobj, 2, abfd, /*rela?*/ true);
3456 
3457 		  if (sreloc == NULL)
3458 		    return false;
3459 		}
3460 
3461 	      /* If this is a global symbol, we count the number of
3462 		 relocations we need for this symbol.  */
3463 	      if (h != NULL)
3464 		{
3465 		  struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
3466 		  struct elf_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3467 
3468 		  rel_head = &h->dyn_relocs;
3469 		  p = *rel_head;
3470 		  if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec)
3471 		    {
3472 		      p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3473 		      if (p == NULL)
3474 			return false;
3475 		      p->next = *rel_head;
3476 		      *rel_head = p;
3477 		      p->sec = sec;
3478 		      p->count = 0;
3479 		      p->pc_count = 0;
3480 		    }
3481 		  p->count += 1;
3482 		  if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
3483 		    p->pc_count += 1;
3484 		}
3485 	      else
3486 		{
3487 		  /* Track dynamic relocs needed for local syms too.
3488 		     We really need local syms available to do this
3489 		     easily.  Oh well.  */
3490 		  struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
3491 		  struct ppc_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3492 		  bool is_ifunc;
3493 		  asection *s;
3494 		  void *vpp;
3495 
3496 		  s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3497 		  if (s == NULL)
3498 		    s = sec;
3499 
3500 		  vpp = &elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel;
3501 		  rel_head = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
3502 		  is_ifunc = ifunc != NULL;
3503 		  p = *rel_head;
3504 		  if (p != NULL && p->sec == sec && p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3505 		    p = p->next;
3506 		  if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec || p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3507 		    {
3508 		      p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3509 		      if (p == NULL)
3510 			return false;
3511 		      p->next = *rel_head;
3512 		      *rel_head = p;
3513 		      p->sec = sec;
3514 		      p->ifunc = is_ifunc;
3515 		      p->count = 0;
3516 		    }
3517 		  p->count += 1;
3518 		}
3519 	    }
3520 
3521 	  break;
3522 	}
3523     }
3524 
3525   return true;
3526 }
3527 
3528 /* Warn for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP attributes between IBFD
3529    and OBFD, and merge non-conflicting ones.  */
3530 bool
_bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes(bfd * ibfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)3531 _bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3532 {
3533   bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3534   obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3535   obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3536   bool ret = true;
3537   bool warn_only;
3538 
3539   /* We only warn about shared library mismatches, because common
3540      libraries advertise support for a particular long double variant
3541      but actually support more than one variant.  For example, glibc
3542      typically supports 128-bit IBM long double in the shared library
3543      but has a compatibility static archive for 64-bit long double.
3544      The linker doesn't have the smarts to see that an app using
3545      object files marked as 64-bit long double call the compatibility
3546      layer objects and only from there call into the shared library.  */
3547   warn_only = (ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0;
3548 
3549   in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3550   out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3551 
3552   in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3553   out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3554 
3555   if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3556     {
3557       int in_fp = in_attr->i & 3;
3558       int out_fp = out_attr->i & 3;
3559       static bfd *last_fp, *last_ld;
3560 
3561       if (in_fp == 0)
3562 	;
3563       else if (out_fp == 0)
3564 	{
3565 	  if (!warn_only)
3566 	    {
3567 	      out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3568 	      out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3569 	      last_fp = ibfd;
3570 	    }
3571 	}
3572       else if (out_fp != 2 && in_fp == 2)
3573 	{
3574 	  _bfd_error_handler
3575 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
3576 	    (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3577 	     last_fp, ibfd);
3578 	  ret = warn_only;
3579 	}
3580       else if (out_fp == 2 && in_fp != 2)
3581 	{
3582 	  _bfd_error_handler
3583 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
3584 	    (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3585 	     ibfd, last_fp);
3586 	  ret = warn_only;
3587 	}
3588       else if (out_fp == 1 && in_fp == 3)
3589 	{
3590 	  _bfd_error_handler
3591 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
3592 	    (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3593 	       "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), last_fp, ibfd);
3594 	  ret = warn_only;
3595 	}
3596       else if (out_fp == 3 && in_fp == 1)
3597 	{
3598 	  _bfd_error_handler
3599 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
3600 	    (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3601 	       "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), ibfd, last_fp);
3602 	  ret = warn_only;
3603 	}
3604 
3605       in_fp = in_attr->i & 0xc;
3606       out_fp = out_attr->i & 0xc;
3607       if (in_fp == 0)
3608 	;
3609       else if (out_fp == 0)
3610 	{
3611 	  if (!warn_only)
3612 	    {
3613 	      out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3614 	      out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3615 	      last_ld = ibfd;
3616 	    }
3617 	}
3618       else if (out_fp != 2 * 4 && in_fp == 2 * 4)
3619 	{
3620 	  _bfd_error_handler
3621 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
3622 	    (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3623 	       "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3624 	  ret = warn_only;
3625 	}
3626       else if (in_fp != 2 * 4 && out_fp == 2 * 4)
3627 	{
3628 	  _bfd_error_handler
3629 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
3630 	    (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3631 	       "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3632 	  ret = warn_only;
3633 	}
3634       else if (out_fp == 1 * 4 && in_fp == 3 * 4)
3635 	{
3636 	  _bfd_error_handler
3637 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
3638 	    (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3639 	       "%pB uses IEEE long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3640 	  ret = warn_only;
3641 	}
3642       else if (out_fp == 3 * 4 && in_fp == 1 * 4)
3643 	{
3644 	  _bfd_error_handler
3645 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
3646 	    (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3647 	       "%pB uses IEEE long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3648 	  ret = warn_only;
3649 	}
3650     }
3651 
3652   if (!ret)
3653     {
3654       out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3655       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3656     }
3657   return ret;
3658 }
3659 
3660 /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD.  Warn if
3661    there are conflicting attributes.  */
3662 static bool
ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes(bfd * ibfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)3663 ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3664 {
3665   bfd *obfd;
3666   obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3667   obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3668   bool ret;
3669 
3670   if (!_bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (ibfd, info))
3671     return false;
3672 
3673   obfd = info->output_bfd;
3674   in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3675   out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3676 
3677   /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector attributes and
3678      merge non-conflicting ones.  */
3679   in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3680   out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3681   ret = true;
3682   if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3683     {
3684       int in_vec = in_attr->i & 3;
3685       int out_vec = out_attr->i & 3;
3686       static bfd *last_vec;
3687 
3688       if (in_vec == 0)
3689 	;
3690       else if (out_vec == 0)
3691 	{
3692 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3693 	  out_attr->i = in_vec;
3694 	  last_vec = ibfd;
3695 	}
3696       /* For now, allow generic to transition to AltiVec or SPE
3697 	 without a warning.  If GCC marked files with their stack
3698 	 alignment and used don't-care markings for files which are
3699 	 not affected by the vector ABI, we could warn about this
3700 	 case too.  */
3701       else if (in_vec == 1)
3702 	;
3703       else if (out_vec == 1)
3704 	{
3705 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3706 	  out_attr->i = in_vec;
3707 	  last_vec = ibfd;
3708 	}
3709       else if (out_vec < in_vec)
3710 	{
3711 	  _bfd_error_handler
3712 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
3713 	    (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3714 	     last_vec, ibfd);
3715 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3716 	  ret = false;
3717 	}
3718       else if (out_vec > in_vec)
3719 	{
3720 	  _bfd_error_handler
3721 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
3722 	    (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3723 	     ibfd, last_vec);
3724 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3725 	  ret = false;
3726 	}
3727     }
3728 
3729   /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return attributes
3730      and merge non-conflicting ones.  */
3731   in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3732   out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3733   if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3734     {
3735       int in_struct = in_attr->i & 3;
3736       int out_struct = out_attr->i & 3;
3737       static bfd *last_struct;
3738 
3739       if (in_struct == 0 || in_struct == 3)
3740        ;
3741       else if (out_struct == 0)
3742 	{
3743 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3744 	  out_attr->i = in_struct;
3745 	  last_struct = ibfd;
3746 	}
3747       else if (out_struct < in_struct)
3748 	{
3749 	  _bfd_error_handler
3750 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
3751 	    (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3752 	       "%pB uses memory"), last_struct, ibfd);
3753 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3754 	  ret = false;
3755 	}
3756       else if (out_struct > in_struct)
3757 	{
3758 	  _bfd_error_handler
3759 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
3760 	    (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3761 	       "%pB uses memory"), ibfd, last_struct);
3762 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3763 	  ret = false;
3764 	}
3765     }
3766   if (!ret)
3767     {
3768       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3769       return false;
3770     }
3771 
3772   /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones.  */
3773   return _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, info);
3774 }
3775 
3776 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
3777    object file when linking.  */
3778 
3779 static bool
ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data(bfd * ibfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)3780 ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3781 {
3782   bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3783   flagword old_flags;
3784   flagword new_flags;
3785   bool error;
3786 
3787   if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd) || !is_ppc_elf (obfd))
3788     return true;
3789 
3790   /* Check if we have the same endianness.  */
3791   if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, info))
3792     return false;
3793 
3794   if (!ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, info))
3795     return false;
3796 
3797   if ((ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
3798     return true;
3799 
3800   new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
3801   old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
3802   if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
3803     {
3804       /* First call, no flags set.  */
3805       elf_flags_init (obfd) = true;
3806       elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
3807     }
3808 
3809   /* Compatible flags are ok.  */
3810   else if (new_flags == old_flags)
3811     ;
3812 
3813   /* Incompatible flags.  */
3814   else
3815     {
3816       /* Warn about -mrelocatable mismatch.  Allow -mrelocatable-lib
3817 	 to be linked with either.  */
3818       error = false;
3819       if ((new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0
3820 	  && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0)
3821 	{
3822 	  error = true;
3823 	  _bfd_error_handler
3824 	    (_("%pB: compiled with -mrelocatable and linked with "
3825 	       "modules compiled normally"), ibfd);
3826 	}
3827       else if ((new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0
3828 	       && (old_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0)
3829 	{
3830 	  error = true;
3831 	  _bfd_error_handler
3832 	    (_("%pB: compiled normally and linked with "
3833 	       "modules compiled with -mrelocatable"), ibfd);
3834 	}
3835 
3836       /* The output is -mrelocatable-lib iff both the input files are.  */
3837       if (! (new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB))
3838 	elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB;
3839 
3840       /* The output is -mrelocatable iff it can't be -mrelocatable-lib,
3841 	 but each input file is either -mrelocatable or -mrelocatable-lib.  */
3842       if (! (elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)
3843 	  && (new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE))
3844 	  && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE)))
3845 	elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE;
3846 
3847       /* Do not warn about eabi vs. V.4 mismatch, just or in the bit if
3848 	 any module uses it.  */
3849       elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= (new_flags & EF_PPC_EMB);
3850 
3851       new_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3852       old_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3853 
3854       /* Warn about any other mismatches.  */
3855       if (new_flags != old_flags)
3856 	{
3857 	  error = true;
3858 	  _bfd_error_handler
3859 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
3860 	    (_("%pB: uses different e_flags (%#x) fields "
3861 	       "than previous modules (%#x)"),
3862 	     ibfd, new_flags, old_flags);
3863 	}
3864 
3865       if (error)
3866 	{
3867 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3868 	  return false;
3869 	}
3870     }
3871 
3872   return true;
3873 }
3874 
3875 static bfd_reloc_status_type
ppc_elf_vle_split16(bfd * input_bfd,asection * input_section,unsigned long offset,bfd_byte * loc,bfd_vma value,split16_format_type split16_format,bool fixup)3876 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (bfd *input_bfd,
3877 		     asection *input_section,
3878 		     unsigned long offset,
3879 		     bfd_byte *loc,
3880 		     bfd_vma value,
3881 		     split16_format_type split16_format,
3882 		     bool fixup)
3883 {
3884   unsigned int insn, opcode;
3885 
3886   if (!offset_in_range (input_section, offset, 4))
3887     return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
3888   insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, loc);
3889   opcode = insn & E_OPCODE_MASK;
3890   if (opcode == E_OR2I_INSN
3891       || opcode == E_AND2I_DOT_INSN
3892       || opcode == E_OR2IS_INSN
3893       || opcode == E_LIS_INSN
3894       || opcode == E_AND2IS_DOT_INSN)
3895     {
3896       if (split16_format != split16a_type)
3897 	{
3898 	  if (fixup)
3899 	    split16_format = split16a_type;
3900 	  else
3901 	    _bfd_error_handler
3902 	      /* xgettext:c-format */
3903 	      (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16A style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3904 	       input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3905 	}
3906     }
3907   else if (opcode == E_ADD2I_DOT_INSN
3908 	   || opcode == E_ADD2IS_INSN
3909 	   || opcode == E_CMP16I_INSN
3910 	   || opcode == E_MULL2I_INSN
3911 	   || opcode == E_CMPL16I_INSN
3912 	   || opcode == E_CMPH16I_INSN
3913 	   || opcode == E_CMPHL16I_INSN)
3914     {
3915       if (split16_format != split16d_type)
3916 	{
3917 	  if (fixup)
3918 	    split16_format = split16d_type;
3919 	  else
3920 	    _bfd_error_handler
3921 	      /* xgettext:c-format */
3922 	      (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16D style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3923 	       input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3924 	}
3925     }
3926   if (split16_format == split16a_type)
3927     {
3928       insn &= ~((0xf800 << 5) | 0x7ff);
3929       insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3930       if ((insn & E_LI_MASK) == E_LI_INSN)
3931 	{
3932 	  /* Hack for e_li.  Extend sign.  */
3933 	  insn &= ~(0xf0000 >> 5);
3934 	  insn |= (-(value & 0x8000) & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3935 	}
3936     }
3937   else
3938     {
3939       insn &= ~((0xf800 << 10) | 0x7ff);
3940       insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 10;
3941     }
3942   insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3943   bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, loc);
3944   return bfd_reloc_ok;
3945 }
3946 
3947 static void
ppc_elf_vle_split20(bfd * output_bfd,bfd_byte * loc,bfd_vma value)3948 ppc_elf_vle_split20 (bfd *output_bfd, bfd_byte *loc, bfd_vma value)
3949 {
3950   unsigned int insn;
3951 
3952   insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
3953   /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31.  */
3954   /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20.  */
3955   insn |= (value & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3956   /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15.  */
3957   insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3958   /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31.  */
3959   insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3960   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, insn, loc);
3961 }
3962 
3963 
3964 /* Choose which PLT scheme to use, and set .plt flags appropriately.
3965    Returns -1 on error, 0 for old PLT, 1 for new PLT.  */
3966 int
ppc_elf_select_plt_layout(bfd * output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,struct bfd_link_info * info)3967 ppc_elf_select_plt_layout (bfd *output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3968 			   struct bfd_link_info *info)
3969 {
3970   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3971   flagword flags;
3972 
3973   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
3974 
3975   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3976     {
3977       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3978 
3979       if (htab->params->plt_style == PLT_OLD)
3980 	htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3981       else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3982 	       && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
3983 	       && (h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "_mcount",
3984 					     false, false, true)) != NULL
3985 	       && (h->type == STT_FUNC
3986 		   || h->needs_plt)
3987 	       && h->ref_regular
3988 	       && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
3989 		    || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
3990 	{
3991 	  /* Profiling of shared libs (and pies) is not supported with
3992 	     secure plt, because ppc32 does profiling before a
3993 	     function prologue and a secure plt pic call stubs needs
3994 	     r30 to be set up.  */
3995 	  htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3996 	}
3997       else
3998 	{
3999 	  bfd *ibfd;
4000 	  enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type = htab->params->plt_style;
4001 
4002 	  /* Look through the reloc flags left by ppc_elf_check_relocs.
4003 	     Use the old style bss plt if a file makes plt calls
4004 	     without using the new relocs, and if ld isn't given
4005 	     --secure-plt and we never see REL16 relocs.  */
4006 	  if (plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
4007 	    plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4008 	  for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4009 	    if (is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4010 	      {
4011 		if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_rel16)
4012 		  plt_type = PLT_NEW;
4013 		else if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->makes_plt_call)
4014 		  {
4015 		    plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4016 		    htab->old_bfd = ibfd;
4017 		    break;
4018 		  }
4019 	      }
4020 	  htab->plt_type = plt_type;
4021 	}
4022     }
4023   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD && htab->params->plt_style == PLT_NEW)
4024     {
4025       if (htab->old_bfd != NULL)
4026 	_bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced due to %pB"), htab->old_bfd);
4027       else
4028 	_bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced by profiling"));
4029     }
4030 
4031   BFD_ASSERT (htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS);
4032 
4033   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
4034     {
4035       flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
4036 	       | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
4037 
4038       /* The new PLT is a loaded section.  */
4039       if (htab->elf.splt != NULL
4040 	  && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.splt, flags))
4041 	return -1;
4042 
4043       /* The new GOT is not executable.  */
4044       if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
4045 	  && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags))
4046 	return -1;
4047     }
4048   else
4049     {
4050       /* Stop an unused .glink section from affecting .text alignment.  */
4051       if (htab->glink != NULL
4052 	  && !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->glink, 0))
4053 	return -1;
4054     }
4055   return htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW;
4056 }
4057 
4058 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
4059    relocation.  */
4060 
4061 static asection *
ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook(asection * sec,struct bfd_link_info * info,Elf_Internal_Rela * rel,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym)4062 ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
4063 		      struct bfd_link_info *info,
4064 		      Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4065 		      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4066 		      Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
4067 {
4068   if (h != NULL)
4069     switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
4070       {
4071       case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
4072       case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
4073 	return NULL;
4074       }
4075 
4076   return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
4077 }
4078 
4079 static bool
get_sym_h(struct elf_link_hash_entry ** hp,Elf_Internal_Sym ** symp,asection ** symsecp,unsigned char ** tls_maskp,Elf_Internal_Sym ** locsymsp,unsigned long r_symndx,bfd * ibfd)4080 get_sym_h (struct elf_link_hash_entry **hp,
4081 	   Elf_Internal_Sym **symp,
4082 	   asection **symsecp,
4083 	   unsigned char **tls_maskp,
4084 	   Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
4085 	   unsigned long r_symndx,
4086 	   bfd *ibfd)
4087 {
4088   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4089 
4090   if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4091     {
4092       struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4093       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4094 
4095       h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4096       while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4097 	     || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4098 	h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4099 
4100       if (hp != NULL)
4101 	*hp = h;
4102 
4103       if (symp != NULL)
4104 	*symp = NULL;
4105 
4106       if (symsecp != NULL)
4107 	{
4108 	  asection *symsec = NULL;
4109 	  if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4110 	      || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4111 	    symsec = h->root.u.def.section;
4112 	  *symsecp = symsec;
4113 	}
4114 
4115       if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4116 	*tls_maskp = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4117     }
4118   else
4119     {
4120       Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4121       Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = *locsymsp;
4122 
4123       if (locsyms == NULL)
4124 	{
4125 	  locsyms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
4126 	  if (locsyms == NULL)
4127 	    locsyms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr,
4128 					    symtab_hdr->sh_info,
4129 					    0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
4130 	  if (locsyms == NULL)
4131 	    return false;
4132 	  *locsymsp = locsyms;
4133 	}
4134       sym = locsyms + r_symndx;
4135 
4136       if (hp != NULL)
4137 	*hp = NULL;
4138 
4139       if (symp != NULL)
4140 	*symp = sym;
4141 
4142       if (symsecp != NULL)
4143 	*symsecp = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx);
4144 
4145       if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4146 	{
4147 	  bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
4148 	  unsigned char *tls_mask;
4149 
4150 	  tls_mask = NULL;
4151 	  local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4152 	  if (local_got != NULL)
4153 	    {
4154 	      struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4155 		(local_got + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4156 	      unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4157 		(local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4158 	      tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4159 	    }
4160 	  *tls_maskp = tls_mask;
4161 	}
4162     }
4163   return true;
4164 }
4165 
4166 /* Analyze inline PLT call relocations to see whether calls to locally
4167    defined functions can be converted to direct calls.  */
4168 
4169 bool
ppc_elf_inline_plt(struct bfd_link_info * info)4170 ppc_elf_inline_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info)
4171 {
4172   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4173   bfd *ibfd;
4174   asection *sec;
4175   bfd_vma low_vma, high_vma, limit;
4176 
4177   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4178   if (htab == NULL)
4179     return false;
4180 
4181   /* A bl insn can reach -0x2000000 to 0x1fffffc.  The limit is
4182      reduced somewhat to cater for possible stubs that might be added
4183      between the call and its destination.  */
4184   limit = 0x1e00000;
4185   low_vma = -1;
4186   high_vma = 0;
4187   for (sec = info->output_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4188     if ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE)) == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE))
4189       {
4190 	if (low_vma > sec->vma)
4191 	  low_vma = sec->vma;
4192 	if (high_vma < sec->vma + sec->size)
4193 	  high_vma = sec->vma + sec->size;
4194       }
4195 
4196   /* If a "bl" can reach anywhere in local code sections, then we can
4197      convert all inline PLT sequences to direct calls when the symbol
4198      is local.  */
4199   if (high_vma - low_vma < limit)
4200     {
4201       htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt = 1;
4202       return true;
4203     }
4204 
4205   /* Otherwise, go looking through relocs for cases where a direct
4206      call won't reach.  Mark the symbol on any such reloc to disable
4207      the optimization and keep the PLT entry as it seems likely that
4208      this will be better than creating trampolines.  Note that this
4209      will disable the optimization for all inline PLT calls to a
4210      particular symbol, not just those that won't reach.  The
4211      difficulty in doing a more precise optimization is that the
4212      linker needs to make a decision depending on whether a
4213      particular R_PPC_PLTCALL insn can be turned into a direct
4214      call, for each of the R_PPC_PLTSEQ and R_PPC_PLT16* insns in
4215      the sequence, and there is nothing that ties those relocs
4216      together except their symbol.  */
4217 
4218   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4219     {
4220       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4221       Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
4222 
4223       if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4224 	continue;
4225 
4226       local_syms = NULL;
4227       symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4228 
4229       for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4230 	if (sec->has_pltcall
4231 	    && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4232 	  {
4233 	    Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4234 
4235 	    /* Read the relocations.  */
4236 	    relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4237 						  info->keep_memory);
4238 	    if (relstart == NULL)
4239 	      return false;
4240 
4241 	    relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4242 	    for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
4243 	      {
4244 		enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4245 		unsigned long r_symndx;
4246 		asection *sym_sec;
4247 		struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4248 		Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4249 		unsigned char *tls_maskp;
4250 
4251 		r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4252 		if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTCALL)
4253 		  continue;
4254 
4255 		r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4256 		if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_maskp, &local_syms,
4257 				r_symndx, ibfd))
4258 		  {
4259 		    if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4260 		      free (relstart);
4261 		    if (symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4262 		      free (local_syms);
4263 		    return false;
4264 		  }
4265 
4266 		if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
4267 		  {
4268 		    bfd_vma from, to;
4269 		    if (h != NULL)
4270 		      to = h->root.u.def.value;
4271 		    else
4272 		      to = sym->st_value;
4273 		    to += (rel->r_addend
4274 			   + sym_sec->output_offset
4275 			   + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
4276 		    from = (rel->r_offset
4277 			    + sec->output_offset
4278 			    + sec->output_section->vma);
4279 		    if (to - from + limit < 2 * limit)
4280 		      *tls_maskp &= ~PLT_KEEP;
4281 		  }
4282 	      }
4283 	    if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4284 	      free (relstart);
4285 	  }
4286 
4287       if (local_syms != NULL
4288 	  && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4289 	{
4290 	  if (!info->keep_memory)
4291 	    free (local_syms);
4292 	  else
4293 	    symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
4294 	}
4295     }
4296 
4297   return true;
4298 }
4299 
4300 /* Set plt output section type, htab->tls_get_addr, and call the
4301    generic ELF tls_setup function.  */
4302 
4303 asection *
ppc_elf_tls_setup(bfd * obfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)4304 ppc_elf_tls_setup (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4305 {
4306   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4307 
4308   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4309   htab->tls_get_addr = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
4310 					     false, false, true);
4311   if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
4312     htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = true;
4313 
4314   if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
4315     {
4316       struct elf_link_hash_entry *opt, *tga;
4317       opt = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr_opt",
4318 				  false, false, true);
4319       if (opt != NULL
4320 	  && (opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4321 	      || opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
4322 	{
4323 	  /* If glibc supports an optimized __tls_get_addr call stub,
4324 	     signalled by the presence of __tls_get_addr_opt, and we'll
4325 	     be calling __tls_get_addr via a plt call stub, then
4326 	     make __tls_get_addr point to __tls_get_addr_opt.  */
4327 	  tga = htab->tls_get_addr;
4328 	  if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
4329 	      && tga != NULL
4330 	      && (tga->type == STT_FUNC
4331 		  || tga->needs_plt)
4332 	      && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, tga)
4333 		   || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, tga)))
4334 	    {
4335 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
4336 	      for (ent = tga->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4337 		if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4338 		  break;
4339 	      if (ent != NULL)
4340 		{
4341 		  tga->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
4342 		  tga->root.u.i.link = &opt->root;
4343 		  ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt, tga);
4344 		  opt->mark = 1;
4345 		  if (opt->dynindx != -1)
4346 		    {
4347 		      /* Use __tls_get_addr_opt in dynamic relocations.  */
4348 		      opt->dynindx = -1;
4349 		      _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
4350 					      opt->dynstr_index);
4351 		      if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, opt))
4352 			return false;
4353 		    }
4354 		  htab->tls_get_addr = opt;
4355 		}
4356 	    }
4357 	}
4358       else
4359 	htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = true;
4360     }
4361   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
4362       && htab->elf.splt != NULL
4363       && htab->elf.splt->output_section != NULL)
4364     {
4365       elf_section_type (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHT_PROGBITS;
4366       elf_section_flags (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE;
4367     }
4368 
4369   return _bfd_elf_tls_setup (obfd, info);
4370 }
4371 
4372 /* Return TRUE iff REL is a branch reloc with a global symbol matching
4373    HASH.  */
4374 
4375 static bool
branch_reloc_hash_match(const bfd * ibfd,const Elf_Internal_Rela * rel,const struct elf_link_hash_entry * hash)4376 branch_reloc_hash_match (const bfd *ibfd,
4377 			 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4378 			 const struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash)
4379 {
4380   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4381   enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4382   unsigned int r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4383 
4384   if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4385     {
4386       struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4387       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4388 
4389       h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4390       while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4391 	     || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4392 	h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4393       if (h == hash)
4394 	return true;
4395     }
4396   return false;
4397 }
4398 
4399 /* Run through all the TLS relocs looking for optimization
4400    opportunities.  */
4401 
4402 bool
ppc_elf_tls_optimize(bfd * obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,struct bfd_link_info * info)4403 ppc_elf_tls_optimize (bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4404 		      struct bfd_link_info *info)
4405 {
4406   bfd *ibfd;
4407   asection *sec;
4408   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4409   int pass;
4410 
4411   if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
4412     return true;
4413 
4414   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4415   if (htab == NULL)
4416     return false;
4417 
4418   htab->do_tls_opt = 1;
4419 
4420   /* Make two passes through the relocs.  First time check that tls
4421      relocs involved in setting up a tls_get_addr call are indeed
4422      followed by such a call.  If they are not, don't do any tls
4423      optimization.  On the second pass twiddle tls_mask flags to
4424      notify relocate_section that optimization can be done, and
4425      adjust got and plt refcounts.  */
4426   for (pass = 0; pass < 2; ++pass)
4427     for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4428       {
4429 	Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4430 	asection *got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".got2");
4431 
4432 	for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4433 	  if (sec->has_tls_reloc && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4434 	    {
4435 	      Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4436 	      int expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4437 
4438 	      /* Read the relocations.  */
4439 	      relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4440 						    info->keep_memory);
4441 	      if (relstart == NULL)
4442 		return false;
4443 
4444 	      relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4445 	      for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
4446 		{
4447 		  enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4448 		  unsigned long r_symndx;
4449 		  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
4450 		  unsigned char *tls_mask;
4451 		  unsigned char tls_set, tls_clear;
4452 		  bool is_local;
4453 		  bfd_signed_vma *got_count;
4454 
4455 		  r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4456 		  if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4457 		    {
4458 		      struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4459 
4460 		      sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4461 		      h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4462 		      while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4463 			     || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4464 			h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4465 		    }
4466 
4467 		  is_local = SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h);
4468 		  r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4469 		  /* If this section has old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4470 		     without marker relocs, then check that each
4471 		     __tls_get_addr call reloc is preceded by a reloc
4472 		     that conceivably belongs to the __tls_get_addr arg
4473 		     setup insn.  If we don't find matching arg setup
4474 		     relocs, don't do any tls optimization.  */
4475 		  if (pass == 0
4476 		      && sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
4477 		      && h != NULL
4478 		      && h == htab->tls_get_addr
4479 		      && !expecting_tls_get_addr
4480 		      && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4481 		    {
4482 		      info->callbacks->minfo ("%H __tls_get_addr lost arg, "
4483 					      "TLS optimization disabled\n",
4484 					      ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4485 		      if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4486 			free (relstart);
4487 		      return true;
4488 		    }
4489 
4490 		  expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4491 		  switch (r_type)
4492 		    {
4493 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
4494 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
4495 		      expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4496 		      /* Fall through.  */
4497 
4498 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
4499 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
4500 		      /* These relocs should never be against a symbol
4501 			 defined in a shared lib.  Leave them alone if
4502 			 that turns out to be the case.  */
4503 		      if (!is_local)
4504 			continue;
4505 
4506 		      /* LD -> LE */
4507 		      tls_set = 0;
4508 		      tls_clear = TLS_LD;
4509 		      break;
4510 
4511 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
4512 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
4513 		      expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4514 		      /* Fall through.  */
4515 
4516 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
4517 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
4518 		      if (is_local)
4519 			/* GD -> LE */
4520 			tls_set = 0;
4521 		      else
4522 			/* GD -> IE */
4523 			tls_set = TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE;
4524 		      tls_clear = TLS_GD;
4525 		      break;
4526 
4527 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
4528 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
4529 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
4530 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
4531 		      if (is_local)
4532 			{
4533 			  /* IE -> LE */
4534 			  tls_set = 0;
4535 			  tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
4536 			  break;
4537 			}
4538 		      else
4539 			continue;
4540 
4541 		    case R_PPC_TLSLD:
4542 		      if (!is_local)
4543 			continue;
4544 		      /* Fall through.  */
4545 		    case R_PPC_TLSGD:
4546 		      if (rel + 1 < relend
4547 			  && is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
4548 			{
4549 			  if (pass != 0
4550 			      && ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) != R_PPC_PLTSEQ)
4551 			    {
4552 			      r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info);
4553 			      r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel[1].r_info);
4554 			      if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4555 				{
4556 				  struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4557 
4558 				  sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4559 				  h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4560 				  while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4561 					 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4562 				    h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4563 				  if (h != NULL)
4564 				    {
4565 				      struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
4566 				      bfd_vma addend = 0;
4567 
4568 				      if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4569 					addend = rel->r_addend;
4570 				      ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist,
4571 							  got2, addend);
4572 				      if (ent != NULL
4573 					  && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4574 					ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4575 				    }
4576 				}
4577 			    }
4578 			  continue;
4579 			}
4580 		      expecting_tls_get_addr = 2;
4581 		      tls_set = 0;
4582 		      tls_clear = 0;
4583 		      break;
4584 
4585 		    case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
4586 		      if (pass == 0)
4587 			{
4588 			  unsigned char buf[4];
4589 			  unsigned int insn;
4590 			  bfd_vma off = rel->r_offset & ~3;
4591 			  if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, buf,
4592 							 off, 4))
4593 			    {
4594 			      if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4595 				free (relstart);
4596 			      return false;
4597 			    }
4598 			  insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf);
4599 			  /* addis rt,2,imm */
4600 			  if ((insn & ((0x3fu << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
4601 			      != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16)))
4602 			    {
4603 			      /* xgettext:c-format */
4604 			      info->callbacks->minfo
4605 				(_("%H: warning: %s unexpected insn %#x.\n"),
4606 				 ibfd, sec, off, "R_PPC_TPREL16_HA", insn);
4607 			      htab->do_tls_opt = 0;
4608 			    }
4609 			}
4610 		      continue;
4611 
4612 		    case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
4613 		      htab->do_tls_opt = 0;
4614 		      continue;
4615 
4616 		    default:
4617 		      continue;
4618 		    }
4619 
4620 		  if (pass == 0)
4621 		    {
4622 		      if (!expecting_tls_get_addr
4623 			  || !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
4624 			continue;
4625 
4626 		      if (rel + 1 < relend
4627 			  && branch_reloc_hash_match (ibfd, rel + 1,
4628 						      htab->tls_get_addr))
4629 			continue;
4630 
4631 		      /* Uh oh, we didn't find the expected call.  We
4632 			 could just mark this symbol to exclude it
4633 			 from tls optimization but it's safer to skip
4634 			 the entire optimization.  */
4635 		      info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H arg lost __tls_get_addr, "
4636 						"TLS optimization disabled\n"),
4637 					      ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4638 		      if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4639 			free (relstart);
4640 		      return true;
4641 		    }
4642 
4643 		  if (h != NULL)
4644 		    {
4645 		      tls_mask = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4646 		      got_count = &h->got.refcount;
4647 		    }
4648 		  else
4649 		    {
4650 		      bfd_signed_vma *lgot_refs;
4651 		      struct plt_entry **local_plt;
4652 		      unsigned char *lgot_masks;
4653 
4654 		      lgot_refs = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4655 		      if (lgot_refs == NULL)
4656 			abort ();
4657 		      local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4658 			(lgot_refs + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4659 		      lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4660 			(local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4661 		      tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4662 		      got_count = &lgot_refs[r_symndx];
4663 		    }
4664 
4665 		  /* If we don't have old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4666 		     without TLSGD/TLSLD marker relocs, and we haven't
4667 		     found a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a
4668 		     marker for this symbol, then we either have a
4669 		     broken object file or an -mlongcall style
4670 		     indirect call to __tls_get_addr without a marker.
4671 		     Disable optimization in this case.  */
4672 		  if ((tls_clear & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0
4673 		      && !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
4674 		      && ((*tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
4675 			  != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK)))
4676 		    continue;
4677 
4678 		  if (expecting_tls_get_addr == 1 + !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
4679 		    {
4680 		      struct plt_entry *ent;
4681 		      bfd_vma addend = 0;
4682 
4683 		      if (bfd_link_pic (info)
4684 			  && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTREL24
4685 			      || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTCALL))
4686 			addend = rel[1].r_addend;
4687 		      ent = find_plt_ent (&htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist,
4688 					  got2, addend);
4689 		      if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4690 			ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4691 		    }
4692 		  if (tls_clear == 0)
4693 		    continue;
4694 
4695 		  if (tls_set == 0)
4696 		    {
4697 		      /* We managed to get rid of a got entry.  */
4698 		      if (*got_count > 0)
4699 			*got_count -= 1;
4700 		    }
4701 
4702 		  *tls_mask |= tls_set;
4703 		  *tls_mask &= ~tls_clear;
4704 		}
4705 
4706 	      if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4707 		free (relstart);
4708 	    }
4709       }
4710   return true;
4711 }
4712 
4713 /* Return true if we have dynamic relocs against H or any of its weak
4714    aliases, that apply to read-only sections.  Cannot be used after
4715    size_dynamic_sections.  */
4716 
4717 static bool
alias_readonly_dynrelocs(struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)4718 alias_readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4719 {
4720   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
4721   do
4722     {
4723       if (_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (&eh->elf))
4724 	return true;
4725       eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (eh->elf.u.alias);
4726     } while (eh != NULL && &eh->elf != h);
4727 
4728   return false;
4729 }
4730 
4731 /* Return whether H has pc-relative dynamic relocs.  */
4732 
4733 static bool
pc_dynrelocs(struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)4734 pc_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4735 {
4736   struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
4737 
4738   for (p = h->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
4739     if (p->pc_count != 0)
4740       return true;
4741   return false;
4742 }
4743 
4744 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
4745    regular object.  The current definition is in some section of the
4746    dynamic object, but we're not including those sections.  We have to
4747    change the definition to something the rest of the link can
4748    understand.  */
4749 
4750 static bool
ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)4751 ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4752 			       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4753 {
4754   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4755   asection *s;
4756 
4757 #ifdef DEBUG
4758   fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol called for %s\n",
4759 	   h->root.root.string);
4760 #endif
4761 
4762   /* Make sure we know what is going on here.  */
4763   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4764   BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL
4765 	      && (h->needs_plt
4766 		  || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4767 		  || h->is_weakalias
4768 		  || (h->def_dynamic
4769 		      && h->ref_regular
4770 		      && !h->def_regular)));
4771 
4772   /* Deal with function syms.  */
4773   if (h->type == STT_FUNC
4774       || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4775       || h->needs_plt)
4776     {
4777       bool local = (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
4778 			   || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h));
4779       /* Discard dyn_relocs when non-pic if we've decided that a
4780 	 function symbol is local.  */
4781       if (!bfd_link_pic (info) && local)
4782 	h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4783 
4784       /* Clear procedure linkage table information for any symbol that
4785 	 won't need a .plt entry.  */
4786       struct plt_entry *ent;
4787       for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4788 	if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4789 	  break;
4790       if (ent == NULL
4791 	  || (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
4792 	      && local
4793 	      && (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
4794 		  || (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
4795 		      & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)))
4796 	{
4797 	  /* A PLT entry is not required/allowed when:
4798 
4799 	     1. We are not using ld.so; because then the PLT entry
4800 	     can't be set up, so we can't use one.  In this case,
4801 	     ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol won't even be called.
4802 
4803 	     2. GC has rendered the entry unused.
4804 
4805 	     3. We know for certain that a call to this symbol
4806 	     will go to this object, or will remain undefined.  */
4807 	  h->plt.plist = NULL;
4808 	  h->needs_plt = 0;
4809 	  h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4810 	}
4811       else
4812 	{
4813 	  /* Taking a function's address in a read/write section
4814 	     doesn't require us to define the function symbol in the
4815 	     executable on a plt call stub.  A dynamic reloc can
4816 	     be used instead, giving better runtime performance.
4817 	     (Calls via that function pointer don't need to bounce
4818 	     through the plt call stub.)  Similarly, use a dynamic
4819 	     reloc for a weak reference when possible, allowing the
4820 	     resolution of the symbol to be set at load time rather
4821 	     than link time.  */
4822 	  if ((h->pointer_equality_needed
4823 	       || (h->non_got_ref
4824 		   && !h->ref_regular_nonweak
4825 		   && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
4826 	      && htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks
4827 	      && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4828 	      && !_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4829 	    {
4830 	      h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4831 	      /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol
4832 		 isn't an ifunc then we don't need a plt entry.  */
4833 	      if (!h->needs_plt && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
4834 		h->plt.plist = NULL;
4835 	    }
4836 	  else if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
4837 	    /* We are going to be defining the function symbol on the
4838 	       plt stub, so no dyn_relocs needed when non-pic.  */
4839 	    h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4840 	}
4841       h->protected_def = 0;
4842       /* Function symbols can't have copy relocs.  */
4843       return true;
4844     }
4845   else
4846     h->plt.plist = NULL;
4847 
4848   /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
4849      processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
4850      real definition first, and we can just use the same value.  */
4851   if (h->is_weakalias)
4852     {
4853       struct elf_link_hash_entry *def = weakdef (h);
4854       BFD_ASSERT (def->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
4855       h->root.u.def.section = def->root.u.def.section;
4856       h->root.u.def.value = def->root.u.def.value;
4857       if (def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss
4858 	  || def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro
4859 	  || def->root.u.def.section == htab->dynsbss)
4860 	h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4861       return true;
4862     }
4863 
4864   /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
4865      is not a function.  */
4866 
4867   /* If we are creating a shared library, we must presume that the
4868      only references to the symbol are via the global offset table.
4869      For such cases we need not do anything here; the relocations will
4870      be handled correctly by relocate_section.  */
4871   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4872     {
4873       h->protected_def = 0;
4874       return true;
4875     }
4876 
4877   /* If there are no references to this symbol that do not use the
4878      GOT, we don't need to generate a copy reloc.  */
4879   if (!h->non_got_ref)
4880     {
4881       h->protected_def = 0;
4882       return true;
4883     }
4884 
4885   /* Protected variables do not work with .dynbss.  The copy in
4886      .dynbss won't be used by the shared library with the protected
4887      definition for the variable.  Editing to PIC, or text relocations
4888      are preferable to an incorrect program.  */
4889   if (h->protected_def)
4890     {
4891       if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4892 	  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
4893 	  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
4894 	  && htab->params->pic_fixup == 0
4895 	  && info->disable_target_specific_optimizations <= 1)
4896 	htab->params->pic_fixup = 1;
4897       return true;
4898     }
4899 
4900   /* If -z nocopyreloc was given, we won't generate them either.  */
4901   if (info->nocopyreloc)
4902     return true;
4903 
4904    /* If we don't find any dynamic relocs in read-only sections, then
4905       we'll be keeping the dynamic relocs and avoiding the copy reloc.
4906       We can't do this if there are any small data relocations.  This
4907       doesn't work on VxWorks, where we can not have dynamic
4908       relocations (other than copy and jump slot relocations) in an
4909       executable.  */
4910   if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4911       && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4912       && htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks
4913       && !h->def_regular
4914       && !alias_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4915     return true;
4916 
4917   /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
4918      become part of the .bss section of the executable.  There will be
4919      an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section.  The dynamic
4920      object will contain position independent code, so all references
4921      from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
4922      offset table.  The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
4923      determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
4924      both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
4925      same memory location for the variable.
4926 
4927      Of course, if the symbol is referenced using SDAREL relocs, we
4928      must instead allocate it in .sbss.  */
4929   if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4930     s = htab->dynsbss;
4931   else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4932     s = htab->elf.sdynrelro;
4933   else
4934     s = htab->elf.sdynbss;
4935   BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
4936 
4937   if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0 && h->size != 0)
4938     {
4939       asection *srel;
4940 
4941       /* We must generate a R_PPC_COPY reloc to tell the dynamic
4942 	 linker to copy the initial value out of the dynamic object
4943 	 and into the runtime process image.  */
4944       if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4945 	srel = htab->relsbss;
4946       else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4947 	srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
4948       else
4949 	srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
4950       BFD_ASSERT (srel != NULL);
4951       srel->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
4952       h->needs_copy = 1;
4953     }
4954 
4955   /* We no longer want dyn_relocs.  */
4956   h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4957   return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (info, h, s);
4958 }
4959 
4960 /* Generate a symbol to mark plt call stubs.  For non-PIC code the sym is
4961    xxxxxxxx.plt_call32.<callee> where xxxxxxxx is a hex number, usually 0,
4962    specifying the addend on the plt relocation.  For -fpic code, the sym
4963    is xxxxxxxx.plt_pic32.<callee>, and for -fPIC
4964    xxxxxxxx.got2.plt_pic32.<callee>.  */
4965 
4966 static bool
add_stub_sym(struct plt_entry * ent,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,struct bfd_link_info * info)4967 add_stub_sym (struct plt_entry *ent,
4968 	      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4969 	      struct bfd_link_info *info)
4970 {
4971   struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
4972   size_t len1, len2, len3;
4973   char *name;
4974   const char *stub;
4975   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4976 
4977   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4978     stub = ".plt_pic32.";
4979   else
4980     stub = ".plt_call32.";
4981 
4982   len1 = strlen (h->root.root.string);
4983   len2 = strlen (stub);
4984   len3 = 0;
4985   if (ent->sec)
4986     len3 = strlen (ent->sec->name);
4987   name = bfd_malloc (len1 + len2 + len3 + 9);
4988   if (name == NULL)
4989     return false;
4990   sprintf (name, "%08x", (unsigned) ent->addend & 0xffffffff);
4991   if (ent->sec)
4992     memcpy (name + 8, ent->sec->name, len3);
4993   memcpy (name + 8 + len3, stub, len2);
4994   memcpy (name + 8 + len3 + len2, h->root.root.string, len1 + 1);
4995   sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, true, false, false);
4996   if (sh == NULL)
4997     return false;
4998   if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
4999     {
5000       sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5001       sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5002       sh->root.u.def.value = ent->glink_offset;
5003       sh->ref_regular = 1;
5004       sh->def_regular = 1;
5005       sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5006       sh->forced_local = 1;
5007       sh->non_elf = 0;
5008       sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5009     }
5010   return true;
5011 }
5012 
5013 /* Allocate NEED contiguous space in .got, and return the offset.
5014    Handles allocation of the got header when crossing 32k.  */
5015 
5016 static bfd_vma
allocate_got(struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table * htab,unsigned int need)5017 allocate_got (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab, unsigned int need)
5018 {
5019   bfd_vma where;
5020   unsigned int max_before_header;
5021 
5022   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5023     {
5024       where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5025       htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5026     }
5027   else
5028     {
5029       max_before_header = htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW ? 32768 : 32764;
5030       if (need <= htab->got_gap)
5031 	{
5032 	  where = max_before_header - htab->got_gap;
5033 	  htab->got_gap -= need;
5034 	}
5035       else
5036 	{
5037 	  if (htab->elf.sgot->size + need > max_before_header
5038 	      && htab->elf.sgot->size <= max_before_header)
5039 	    {
5040 	      htab->got_gap = max_before_header - htab->elf.sgot->size;
5041 	      htab->elf.sgot->size = max_before_header + htab->got_header_size;
5042 	    }
5043 	  where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5044 	  htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5045 	}
5046     }
5047   return where;
5048 }
5049 
5050 /* Calculate size of GOT entries for symbol given its TLS_MASK.
5051    TLS_LD is excluded because those go in a special GOT slot.  */
5052 
5053 static inline unsigned int
got_entries_needed(int tls_mask)5054 got_entries_needed (int tls_mask)
5055 {
5056   unsigned int need;
5057   if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) == 0)
5058     need = 4;
5059   else
5060     {
5061       need = 0;
5062       if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
5063 	need += 8;
5064       if ((tls_mask & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
5065 	need += 4;
5066       if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
5067 	need += 4;
5068     }
5069   return need;
5070 }
5071 
5072 /* If H is undefined, make it dynamic if that makes sense.  */
5073 
5074 static bool
ensure_undef_dynamic(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)5075 ensure_undef_dynamic (struct bfd_link_info *info,
5076 		      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5077 {
5078   struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
5079 
5080   if (htab->dynamic_sections_created
5081       && ((info->dynamic_undefined_weak != 0
5082 	   && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
5083 	  || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
5084       && h->dynindx == -1
5085       && !h->forced_local
5086       && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT)
5087     return bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h);
5088   return true;
5089 }
5090 
5091 /* Choose whether to use htab->iplt or htab->pltlocal rather than the
5092    usual htab->elf.splt section for a PLT entry.  */
5093 
5094 static inline
use_local_plt(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)5095 bool use_local_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info,
5096 			   struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5097 {
5098   return (h == NULL
5099 	  || h->dynindx == -1
5100 	  || !elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created);
5101 }
5102 
5103 /* Allocate space in associated reloc sections for dynamic relocs.  */
5104 
5105 static bool
allocate_dynrelocs(struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,void * inf)5106 allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
5107 {
5108   struct bfd_link_info *info = inf;
5109   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
5110   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5111   struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
5112 
5113   if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5114     return true;
5115 
5116   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5117   eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
5118   if (eh->elf.got.refcount > 0
5119       || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
5120 	  && !eh->elf.def_regular
5121 	  && eh->elf.protected_def
5122 	  && eh->has_addr16_ha
5123 	  && eh->has_addr16_lo
5124 	  && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5125     {
5126       unsigned int need;
5127 
5128       /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol.  */
5129       if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, &eh->elf))
5130 	return false;
5131 
5132       need = 0;
5133       if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5134 	{
5135 	  if (SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf))
5136 	    /* We'll just use htab->tlsld_got.offset.  This should
5137 	       always be the case.  It's a little odd if we have
5138 	       a local dynamic reloc against a non-local symbol.  */
5139 	    htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5140 	  else
5141 	    need += 8;
5142 	}
5143       need += got_entries_needed (eh->tls_mask);
5144       if (need == 0)
5145 	eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5146       else
5147 	{
5148 	  eh->elf.got.offset = allocate_got (htab, need);
5149 	  if (((bfd_link_pic (info)
5150 		&& !((eh->tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
5151 		     && bfd_link_executable (info)
5152 		     && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf))
5153 		&& !bfd_is_abs_symbol (&h->root))
5154 	       || (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5155 		   && eh->elf.dynindx != -1
5156 		   && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)))
5157 	      && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &eh->elf))
5158 	    {
5159 	      asection *rsec;
5160 
5161 	      need *= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
5162 	      if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5163 		need -= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5164 	      rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
5165 	      if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5166 		rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
5167 	      rsec->size += need;
5168 	    }
5169 	}
5170     }
5171   else
5172     eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5173 
5174   /* If no dynamic sections we can't have dynamic relocs, except for
5175      IFUNCs which are handled even in static executables.  */
5176   if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5177       && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5178     h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5179 
5180   /* Discard relocs on undefined symbols that must be local.  */
5181   else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
5182 	   && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
5183     h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5184 
5185   /* Also discard relocs on undefined weak syms with non-default
5186      visibility, or when dynamic_undefined_weak says so.  */
5187   else if (UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
5188     h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5189 
5190   if (h->dyn_relocs == NULL)
5191     ;
5192 
5193   /* In the shared -Bsymbolic case, discard space allocated for
5194      dynamic pc-relative relocs against symbols which turn out to be
5195      defined in regular objects.  For the normal shared case, discard
5196      space for relocs that have become local due to symbol visibility
5197      changes.  */
5198   else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5199     {
5200       /* Relocs that use pc_count are those that appear on a call insn,
5201 	 or certain REL relocs (see must_be_dyn_reloc) that can be
5202 	 generated via assembly.  We want calls to protected symbols to
5203 	 resolve directly to the function rather than going via the plt.
5204 	 If people want function pointer comparisons to work as expected
5205 	 then they should avoid writing weird assembly.  */
5206       if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
5207 	{
5208 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5209 
5210 	  for (pp = &h->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5211 	    {
5212 	      p->count -= p->pc_count;
5213 	      p->pc_count = 0;
5214 	      if (p->count == 0)
5215 		*pp = p->next;
5216 	      else
5217 		pp = &p->next;
5218 	    }
5219 	}
5220 
5221       if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks)
5222 	{
5223 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5224 
5225 	  for (pp = &h->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5226 	    {
5227 	      if (strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name, ".tls_vars") == 0)
5228 		*pp = p->next;
5229 	      else
5230 		pp = &p->next;
5231 	    }
5232 	}
5233 
5234       if (h->dyn_relocs != NULL)
5235 	{
5236 	  /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol.  */
5237 	  if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5238 	    return false;
5239 	}
5240     }
5241   else if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS)
5242     {
5243       /* For the non-pic case, discard space for relocs against
5244 	 symbols which turn out to need copy relocs or are not
5245 	 dynamic.  */
5246       if ((h->dynamic_adjusted
5247 	   || (h->ref_regular
5248 	       && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
5249 	       && (info->dynamic_undefined_weak > 0
5250 		   || !_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (h))))
5251 	  && !h->def_regular
5252 	  && !ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (h)
5253 	  && !(h->protected_def
5254 	       && eh->has_addr16_ha
5255 	       && eh->has_addr16_lo
5256 	       && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5257 	{
5258 	  /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol.  */
5259 	  if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5260 	    return false;
5261 
5262 	  if (h->dynindx == -1)
5263 	    h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5264 	}
5265       else
5266 	h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5267     }
5268 
5269   /* Allocate space.  */
5270   for (p = h->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
5271     {
5272       asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5273       if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5274 	sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5275       sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5276     }
5277 
5278   /* Handle PLT relocs.  Done last, after dynindx has settled.
5279      We might need a PLT entry when the symbol
5280      a) is dynamic, or
5281      b) is an ifunc, or
5282      c) has plt16 relocs and has been processed by adjust_dynamic_symbol, or
5283      d) has plt16 relocs and we are linking statically.  */
5284   if ((htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created && h->dynindx != -1)
5285       || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
5286       || (h->needs_plt && h->dynamic_adjusted)
5287       || (h->needs_plt
5288 	  && h->def_regular
5289 	  && !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5290 	  && !htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5291 	  && (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
5292 	      & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) == PLT_KEEP))
5293     {
5294       struct plt_entry *ent;
5295       bool doneone = false;
5296       bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5297 
5298       for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5299 	if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5300 	  {
5301 	    asection *s;
5302 	    bool dyn;
5303 
5304 	    if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5305 	      return false;
5306 
5307 	    dyn = !use_local_plt (info, h);
5308 	    s = htab->elf.splt;
5309 	    if (!dyn)
5310 	      {
5311 		if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5312 		  s = htab->elf.iplt;
5313 		else
5314 		  s = htab->pltlocal;
5315 	      }
5316 
5317 	    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
5318 	      {
5319 		if (!doneone)
5320 		  {
5321 		    plt_offset = s->size;
5322 		    s->size += 4;
5323 		  }
5324 		ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5325 
5326 		if (s == htab->pltlocal)
5327 		  ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5328 		else
5329 		  {
5330 		    s = htab->glink;
5331 		    if (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info))
5332 		      {
5333 			glink_offset = s->size;
5334 			s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
5335 		      }
5336 		    if (!doneone
5337 			&& !bfd_link_pic (info)
5338 			&& h->def_dynamic
5339 			&& !h->def_regular)
5340 		      {
5341 			h->root.u.def.section = s;
5342 			h->root.u.def.value = glink_offset;
5343 		      }
5344 		    ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5345 
5346 		    if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms
5347 			&& !add_stub_sym (ent, h, info))
5348 		      return false;
5349 		  }
5350 	      }
5351 	    else
5352 	      {
5353 		if (!doneone)
5354 		  {
5355 		    /* If this is the first .plt entry, make room
5356 		       for the special first entry.  */
5357 		    if (s->size == 0)
5358 		      s->size += htab->plt_initial_entry_size;
5359 
5360 		    /* The PowerPC PLT is actually composed of two
5361 		       parts, the first part is 2 words (for a load
5362 		       and a jump), and then there is a remaining
5363 		       word available at the end.  */
5364 		    plt_offset = (htab->plt_initial_entry_size
5365 				  + (htab->plt_slot_size
5366 				     * ((s->size
5367 					 - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5368 					/ htab->plt_entry_size)));
5369 
5370 		    /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular
5371 		       file, and we are not generating a shared
5372 		       library, then set the symbol to this location
5373 		       in the .plt.  This is to avoid text
5374 		       relocations, and is required to make
5375 		       function pointers compare as equal between
5376 		       the normal executable and the shared library.  */
5377 		    if (! bfd_link_pic (info)
5378 			&& h->def_dynamic
5379 			&& !h->def_regular)
5380 		      {
5381 			h->root.u.def.section = s;
5382 			h->root.u.def.value = plt_offset;
5383 		      }
5384 
5385 		    /* Make room for this entry.  */
5386 		    s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5387 		    /* After the 8192nd entry, room for two entries
5388 		       is allocated.  */
5389 		    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
5390 			&& (s->size - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5391 			/ htab->plt_entry_size
5392 			> PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES)
5393 		      s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5394 		  }
5395 		ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5396 	      }
5397 
5398 	    /* We also need to make an entry in the .rela.plt section.  */
5399 	    if (!doneone)
5400 	      {
5401 		if (!dyn)
5402 		  {
5403 		    if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5404 		      {
5405 			s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5406 			s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5407 		      }
5408 		    else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5409 		      {
5410 			s = htab->relpltlocal;
5411 			s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5412 		      }
5413 		  }
5414 		else
5415 		  {
5416 		    htab->elf.srelplt->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5417 
5418 		    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5419 		      {
5420 			/* Allocate space for the unloaded relocations.  */
5421 			if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
5422 			    && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5423 			  {
5424 			    if (ent->plt.offset
5425 				== (bfd_vma) htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5426 			      {
5427 				htab->srelplt2->size
5428 				  += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5429 				      * VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS);
5430 			      }
5431 
5432 			    htab->srelplt2->size
5433 			      += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5434 				  * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS);
5435 			  }
5436 
5437 			/* Every PLT entry has an associated GOT entry in
5438 			   .got.plt.  */
5439 			htab->elf.sgotplt->size += 4;
5440 		      }
5441 		  }
5442 		doneone = true;
5443 	      }
5444 	  }
5445 	else
5446 	  ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5447 
5448       if (!doneone)
5449 	{
5450 	  h->plt.plist = NULL;
5451 	  h->needs_plt = 0;
5452 	}
5453     }
5454   else
5455     {
5456       h->plt.plist = NULL;
5457       h->needs_plt = 0;
5458     }
5459 
5460   return true;
5461 }
5462 
5463 static const unsigned char glink_eh_frame_cie[] =
5464 {
5465   0, 0, 0, 16,				/* length.  */
5466   0, 0, 0, 0,				/* id.  */
5467   1,					/* CIE version.  */
5468   'z', 'R', 0,				/* Augmentation string.  */
5469   4,					/* Code alignment.  */
5470   0x7c,					/* Data alignment.  */
5471   65,					/* RA reg.  */
5472   1,					/* Augmentation size.  */
5473   DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4,	/* FDE encoding.  */
5474   DW_CFA_def_cfa, 1, 0			/* def_cfa: r1 offset 0.  */
5475 };
5476 
5477 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections.  */
5478 
5479 static bool
ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)5480 ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
5481 			       struct bfd_link_info *info)
5482 {
5483   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5484   asection *s;
5485   bool relocs;
5486   bfd *ibfd;
5487 
5488 #ifdef DEBUG
5489   fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections called\n");
5490 #endif
5491 
5492   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5493   BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL);
5494 
5495   if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
5496     {
5497       /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter.  */
5498       if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp)
5499 	{
5500 	  s = bfd_get_linker_section (htab->elf.dynobj, ".interp");
5501 	  BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
5502 	  s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5503 	  s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5504 	}
5505     }
5506 
5507   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5508     htab->got_header_size = 16;
5509   else if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
5510     htab->got_header_size = 12;
5511 
5512   /* Set up .got offsets for local syms, and space for local dynamic
5513      relocs.  */
5514   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
5515     {
5516       bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
5517       bfd_signed_vma *end_local_got;
5518       struct plt_entry **local_plt;
5519       struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
5520       char *lgot_masks;
5521       bfd_size_type locsymcount;
5522       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
5523       Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
5524       Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
5525 
5526       if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
5527 	continue;
5528 
5529       for (s = ibfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5530 	{
5531 	  struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
5532 
5533 	  for (p = ((struct ppc_dyn_relocs *)
5534 		    elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel);
5535 	       p != NULL;
5536 	       p = p->next)
5537 	    {
5538 	      if (!bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec)
5539 		  && bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec->output_section))
5540 		{
5541 		  /* Input section has been discarded, either because
5542 		     it is a copy of a linkonce section or due to
5543 		     linker script /DISCARD/, so we'll be discarding
5544 		     the relocs too.  */
5545 		}
5546 	      else if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
5547 		       && strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name,
5548 				  ".tls_vars") == 0)
5549 		{
5550 		  /* Relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections are
5551 		     handled specially by the loader.  */
5552 		}
5553 	      else if (p->count != 0)
5554 		{
5555 		  asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5556 		  if (p->ifunc)
5557 		    sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5558 		  sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5559 		  if ((p->sec->output_section->flags
5560 		       & (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5561 		      == (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5562 		    {
5563 		      info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5564 		      info->callbacks->minfo (_("%pB: dynamic relocation in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
5565 					      p->sec->owner, p->sec);
5566 		    }
5567 		}
5568 	    }
5569 	}
5570 
5571       local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
5572       if (!local_got)
5573 	continue;
5574 
5575       symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
5576       locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5577       end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
5578       local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
5579       end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
5580       lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5581       local_syms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
5582       if (local_syms == NULL && locsymcount != 0)
5583 	{
5584 	  local_syms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr, locsymcount,
5585 					     0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
5586 	  if (local_syms == NULL)
5587 	    return false;
5588 	}
5589 
5590       for (isym = local_syms;
5591 	   local_got < end_local_got;
5592 	   ++local_got, ++lgot_masks, ++isym)
5593 	if (*local_got > 0)
5594 	  {
5595 	    unsigned int need;
5596 	    if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5597 	      htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5598 	    need = got_entries_needed (*lgot_masks);
5599 	    if (need == 0)
5600 	      *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5601 	    else
5602 	      {
5603 		*local_got = allocate_got (htab, need);
5604 		if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5605 		    && !((*lgot_masks & TLS_TLS) != 0
5606 			 && bfd_link_executable (info))
5607 		    && isym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)
5608 		  {
5609 		    asection *srel;
5610 
5611 		    need *= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
5612 		    srel = htab->elf.srelgot;
5613 		    if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5614 		      srel = htab->elf.irelplt;
5615 		    srel->size += need;
5616 		  }
5617 	      }
5618 	  }
5619 	else
5620 	  *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5621 
5622       if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks)
5623 	continue;
5624 
5625       /* Allocate space for calls to local STT_GNU_IFUNC syms in .iplt.  */
5626       lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5627       for (; local_plt < end_local_plt; ++local_plt, ++lgot_masks)
5628 	{
5629 	  struct plt_entry *ent;
5630 	  bool doneone = false;
5631 	  bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5632 
5633 	  for (ent = *local_plt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5634 	    if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5635 	      {
5636 		if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5637 		  s = htab->elf.iplt;
5638 		else if (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5639 			 || (*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)
5640 		  {
5641 		    ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5642 		    continue;
5643 		  }
5644 		else
5645 		  s = htab->pltlocal;
5646 
5647 		if (!doneone)
5648 		  {
5649 		    plt_offset = s->size;
5650 		    s->size += 4;
5651 		  }
5652 		ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5653 
5654 		if (s != htab->pltlocal && (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info)))
5655 		  {
5656 		    s = htab->glink;
5657 		    glink_offset = s->size;
5658 		    s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, NULL);
5659 		  }
5660 		ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5661 
5662 		if (!doneone)
5663 		  {
5664 		    if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5665 		      {
5666 			s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5667 			s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5668 		      }
5669 		    else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5670 		      {
5671 			s = htab->relpltlocal;
5672 			s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5673 		      }
5674 		    doneone = true;
5675 		  }
5676 	      }
5677 	    else
5678 	      ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5679 	}
5680 
5681       if (local_syms != NULL
5682 	  && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
5683 	{
5684 	  if (!info->keep_memory)
5685 	    free (local_syms);
5686 	  else
5687 	    symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
5688 	}
5689     }
5690 
5691   /* Allocate space for global sym dynamic relocs.  */
5692   elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), allocate_dynrelocs, info);
5693 
5694   if (htab->tlsld_got.refcount > 0)
5695     {
5696       htab->tlsld_got.offset = allocate_got (htab, 8);
5697       if (bfd_link_dll (info))
5698 	htab->elf.srelgot->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5699     }
5700   else
5701     htab->tlsld_got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5702 
5703   if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL && htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS)
5704     {
5705       unsigned int g_o_t = 32768;
5706 
5707       /* If we haven't allocated the header, do so now.  When we get here,
5708 	 for old plt/got the got size will be 0 to 32764 (not allocated),
5709 	 or 32780 to 65536 (header allocated).  For new plt/got, the
5710 	 corresponding ranges are 0 to 32768 and 32780 to 65536.  */
5711       if (htab->elf.sgot->size <= 32768)
5712 	{
5713 	  g_o_t = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5714 	  if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5715 	    g_o_t += 4;
5716 	  htab->elf.sgot->size += htab->got_header_size;
5717 	}
5718 
5719       htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = g_o_t;
5720     }
5721   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5722     {
5723       struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5724 
5725       sda->root.u.def.section = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section;
5726       sda->root.u.def.value = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
5727     }
5728   if (info->emitrelocations)
5729     {
5730       struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5731 
5732       if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5733 	sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5734       sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
5735       if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5736 	sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5737     }
5738 
5739   if (htab->glink != NULL
5740       && htab->glink->size != 0
5741       && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5742     {
5743       htab->glink_pltresolve = htab->glink->size;
5744       /* Space for the branch table.  */
5745       htab->glink->size
5746 	+= htab->elf.srelplt->size / (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4) - 4;
5747       /* Pad out to align the start of PLTresolve.  */
5748       htab->glink->size += -htab->glink->size & (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
5749 						 ? 63 : 15);
5750       htab->glink->size += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5751 
5752       if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
5753 	{
5754 	  struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
5755 	  sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink",
5756 				     true, false, false);
5757 	  if (sh == NULL)
5758 	    return false;
5759 	  if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5760 	    {
5761 	      sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5762 	      sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5763 	      sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink_pltresolve;
5764 	      sh->ref_regular = 1;
5765 	      sh->def_regular = 1;
5766 	      sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5767 	      sh->forced_local = 1;
5768 	      sh->non_elf = 0;
5769 	      sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5770 	    }
5771 	  sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink_PLTresolve",
5772 				     true, false, false);
5773 	  if (sh == NULL)
5774 	    return false;
5775 	  if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5776 	    {
5777 	      sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5778 	      sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5779 	      sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5780 	      sh->ref_regular = 1;
5781 	      sh->def_regular = 1;
5782 	      sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5783 	      sh->forced_local = 1;
5784 	      sh->non_elf = 0;
5785 	      sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5786 	    }
5787 	}
5788     }
5789 
5790   if (htab->glink != NULL
5791       && htab->glink->size != 0
5792       && htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5793       && !bfd_is_abs_section (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section)
5794       && _bfd_elf_eh_frame_present (info))
5795     {
5796       s = htab->glink_eh_frame;
5797       s->size = sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + 20;
5798       if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5799 	{
5800 	  s->size += 4;
5801 	  if (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8 >= 256)
5802 	    s->size += 4;
5803 	}
5804     }
5805 
5806   /* We've now determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections.
5807      Allocate memory for them.  */
5808   relocs = false;
5809   for (s = htab->elf.dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5810     {
5811       bool strip_section = true;
5812 
5813       if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
5814 	continue;
5815 
5816       if (s == htab->elf.splt
5817 	  || s == htab->elf.sgot)
5818 	{
5819 	  /* We'd like to strip these sections if they aren't needed, but if
5820 	     we've exported dynamic symbols from them we must leave them.
5821 	     It's too late to tell BFD to get rid of the symbols.  */
5822 	  if (htab->elf.hplt != NULL)
5823 	    strip_section = false;
5824 	  /* Strip this section if we don't need it; see the
5825 	     comment below.  */
5826 	}
5827       else if (s == htab->elf.iplt
5828 	       || s == htab->pltlocal
5829 	       || s == htab->glink
5830 	       || s == htab->glink_eh_frame
5831 	       || s == htab->elf.sgotplt
5832 	       || s == htab->sbss
5833 	       || s == htab->elf.sdynbss
5834 	       || s == htab->elf.sdynrelro
5835 	       || s == htab->dynsbss)
5836 	{
5837 	  /* Strip these too.  */
5838 	}
5839       else if (s == htab->sdata[0].section
5840 	       || s == htab->sdata[1].section)
5841 	{
5842 	  strip_section = (s->flags & SEC_KEEP) == 0;
5843 	}
5844       else if (startswith (bfd_section_name (s), ".rela"))
5845 	{
5846 	  if (s->size != 0)
5847 	    {
5848 	      /* Remember whether there are any relocation sections.  */
5849 	      relocs = true;
5850 
5851 	      /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
5852 		 to copy relocs into the output file.  */
5853 	      s->reloc_count = 0;
5854 	    }
5855 	}
5856       else
5857 	{
5858 	  /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space.  */
5859 	  continue;
5860 	}
5861 
5862       if (s->size == 0 && strip_section)
5863 	{
5864 	  /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the
5865 	     output file.  This is mostly to handle .rela.bss and
5866 	     .rela.plt.  We must create both sections in
5867 	     create_dynamic_sections, because they must be created
5868 	     before the linker maps input sections to output
5869 	     sections.  The linker does that before
5870 	     adjust_dynamic_symbol is called, and it is that
5871 	     function which decides whether anything needs to go
5872 	     into these sections.  */
5873 	  s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
5874 	  continue;
5875 	}
5876 
5877       if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
5878 	continue;
5879 
5880       /* Allocate memory for the section contents.  */
5881       s->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->elf.dynobj, s->size);
5882       if (s->contents == NULL)
5883 	return false;
5884     }
5885 
5886   if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5887     {
5888       /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section.  We fill in the
5889 	 values later, in ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
5890 	 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
5891 	 the .dynamic section.  The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
5892 	 dynamic linker and used by the debugger.  */
5893 #define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
5894   _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
5895 
5896       if (!_bfd_elf_maybe_vxworks_add_dynamic_tags (output_bfd, info,
5897 						    relocs))
5898 	return false;
5899 
5900       if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
5901 	  && htab->glink != NULL
5902 	  && htab->glink->size != 0)
5903 	{
5904 	  if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_GOT, 0))
5905 	    return false;
5906 	  if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt
5907 	      && htab->tls_get_addr != NULL
5908 	      && htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist != NULL
5909 	      && !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_OPT, PPC_OPT_TLS))
5910 	    return false;
5911 	}
5912    }
5913 #undef add_dynamic_entry
5914 
5915   if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5916       && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
5917     {
5918       unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5919       bfd_vma val;
5920 
5921       memcpy (p, glink_eh_frame_cie, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie));
5922       /* CIE length (rewrite in case little-endian).  */
5923       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) - 4, p);
5924       p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5925       /* FDE length.  */
5926       val = htab->glink_eh_frame->size - 4 - sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5927       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5928       p += 4;
5929       /* CIE pointer.  */
5930       val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5931       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5932       p += 4;
5933       /* Offset to .glink.  Set later.  */
5934       p += 4;
5935       /* .glink size.  */
5936       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink->size, p);
5937       p += 4;
5938       /* Augmentation.  */
5939       p += 1;
5940 
5941       if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5942 	  && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5943 	{
5944 	  bfd_vma adv = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8) >> 2;
5945 	  if (adv < 64)
5946 	    *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + adv;
5947 	  else if (adv < 256)
5948 	    {
5949 	      *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc1;
5950 	      *p++ = adv;
5951 	    }
5952 	  else if (adv < 65536)
5953 	    {
5954 	      *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc2;
5955 	      bfd_put_16 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5956 	      p += 2;
5957 	    }
5958 	  else
5959 	    {
5960 	      *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
5961 	      bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5962 	      p += 4;
5963 	    }
5964 	  *p++ = DW_CFA_register;
5965 	  *p++ = 65;
5966 	  p++;
5967 	  *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 4;
5968 	  *p++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
5969 	  *p++ = 65;
5970 	}
5971       BFD_ASSERT ((bfd_vma) ((p + 3 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents) & -4)
5972 		  == htab->glink_eh_frame->size);
5973     }
5974 
5975   return true;
5976 }
5977 
5978 /* Arrange to have _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_ stripped from the output
5979    if it looks like nothing is using them.  */
5980 
5981 static void
maybe_strip_sdasym(bfd * output_bfd,elf_linker_section_t * lsect)5982 maybe_strip_sdasym (bfd *output_bfd, elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
5983 {
5984   struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = lsect->sym;
5985 
5986   if (sda != NULL && !sda->ref_regular && sda->dynindx == -1)
5987     {
5988       asection *s;
5989 
5990       s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->name);
5991       if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
5992 	{
5993 	  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->bss_name);
5994 	  if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
5995 	    {
5996 	      sda->def_regular = 0;
5997 	      /* This is somewhat magic.  See elf_link_output_extsym.  */
5998 	      sda->ref_dynamic = 1;
5999 	      sda->forced_local = 0;
6000 	    }
6001 	}
6002     }
6003 }
6004 
6005 void
ppc_elf_maybe_strip_sdata_syms(struct bfd_link_info * info)6006 ppc_elf_maybe_strip_sdata_syms (struct bfd_link_info *info)
6007 {
6008   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6009 
6010   if (htab != NULL)
6011     {
6012       maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[0]);
6013       maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[1]);
6014     }
6015 }
6016 
6017 
6018 /* Return TRUE if symbol should be hashed in the `.gnu.hash' section.  */
6019 
6020 static bool
ppc_elf_hash_symbol(struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)6021 ppc_elf_hash_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6022 {
6023   if (h->plt.plist != NULL
6024       && !h->def_regular
6025       && (!h->pointer_equality_needed
6026 	  || !h->ref_regular_nonweak))
6027     return false;
6028 
6029   return _bfd_elf_hash_symbol (h);
6030 }
6031 
6032 #define ARRAY_SIZE(a) (sizeof (a) / sizeof ((a)[0]))
6033 
6034 /* Relaxation trampolines.  r12 is available for clobbering (r11, is
6035    used for some functions that are allowed to break the ABI).  */
6036 static const int shared_stub_entry[] =
6037   {
6038     0x7c0802a6, /* mflr 0 */
6039     0x429f0005, /* bcl 20, 31, .Lxxx */
6040     0x7d8802a6, /* mflr 12 */
6041     0x3d8c0000, /* addis 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@ha */
6042     0x398c0000, /* addi 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@l */
6043     0x7c0803a6, /* mtlr 0 */
6044     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6045     0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6046   };
6047 
6048 static const int stub_entry[] =
6049   {
6050     0x3d800000, /* lis 12,xxx@ha */
6051     0x398c0000, /* addi 12,12,xxx@l */
6052     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6053     0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6054   };
6055 
6056 struct ppc_elf_relax_info
6057 {
6058   unsigned int workaround_size;
6059   unsigned int picfixup_size;
6060 };
6061 
6062 /* This function implements long branch trampolines, and the ppc476
6063    icache bug workaround.  Any section needing trampolines or patch
6064    space for the workaround has its size extended so that we can
6065    add trampolines at the end of the section.  */
6066 
6067 static bool
ppc_elf_relax_section(bfd * abfd,asection * isec,struct bfd_link_info * link_info,bool * again)6068 ppc_elf_relax_section (bfd *abfd,
6069 		       asection *isec,
6070 		       struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
6071 		       bool *again)
6072 {
6073   struct one_branch_fixup
6074   {
6075     struct one_branch_fixup *next;
6076     asection *tsec;
6077     /* Final link, can use the symbol offset.  For a
6078        relocatable link we use the symbol's index.  */
6079     bfd_vma toff;
6080     bfd_vma trampoff;
6081   };
6082 
6083   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6084   bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
6085   Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
6086   Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs = NULL;
6087   Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend = NULL;
6088   struct one_branch_fixup *branch_fixups = NULL;
6089   struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
6090   unsigned changes = 0;
6091   bool workaround_change;
6092   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6093   bfd_size_type trampbase, trampoff, newsize, picfixup_size;
6094   asection *got2;
6095   bool maybe_pasted;
6096 
6097   *again = false;
6098 
6099   /* No need to do anything with non-alloc or non-code sections.  */
6100   if ((isec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
6101       || (isec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
6102       || (isec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
6103       || isec->size < 4)
6104     return true;
6105 
6106   /* We cannot represent the required PIC relocs in the output, so don't
6107      do anything.  The linker doesn't support mixing -shared and -r
6108      anyway.  */
6109   if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6110     return true;
6111 
6112   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (link_info);
6113   if (htab == NULL)
6114     return true;
6115 
6116   isec->size = (isec->size + 3) & -4;
6117   if (isec->rawsize == 0)
6118     isec->rawsize = isec->size;
6119   trampbase = isec->size;
6120 
6121   BFD_ASSERT (isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_NONE
6122 	      || isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET);
6123   isec->sec_info_type = SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET;
6124 
6125   if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6126       || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6127     {
6128       if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6129 	{
6130 	  elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info
6131 	    = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_relax_info));
6132 	  if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6133 	    return false;
6134 	}
6135       relax_info = elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info;
6136       trampbase -= relax_info->workaround_size;
6137     }
6138 
6139   maybe_pasted = (strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
6140 		  || strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0);
6141   /* Space for a branch around any trampolines.  */
6142   trampoff = trampbase;
6143   if (maybe_pasted && trampbase == isec->rawsize)
6144     trampoff += 4;
6145 
6146   symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
6147   picfixup_size = 0;
6148   if (htab->params->branch_trampolines
6149       || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6150     {
6151       /* Get a copy of the native relocations.  */
6152       if (isec->reloc_count != 0)
6153 	{
6154 	  internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, isec, NULL, NULL,
6155 						       link_info->keep_memory);
6156 	  if (internal_relocs == NULL)
6157 	    goto error_return;
6158 	}
6159 
6160       got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
6161 
6162       irelend = internal_relocs + isec->reloc_count;
6163       for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
6164 	{
6165 	  unsigned long r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
6166 	  bfd_vma toff, roff;
6167 	  asection *tsec;
6168 	  struct one_branch_fixup *f;
6169 	  size_t insn_offset = 0;
6170 	  bfd_vma max_branch_offset = 0, val;
6171 	  bfd_byte *hit_addr;
6172 	  unsigned long t0;
6173 	  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6174 	  Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
6175 	  struct plt_entry **plist;
6176 	  unsigned char sym_type;
6177 
6178 	  switch (r_type)
6179 	    {
6180 	    case R_PPC_REL24:
6181 	    case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6182 	    case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6183 	    case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
6184 	      max_branch_offset = 1 << 25;
6185 	      break;
6186 
6187 	    case R_PPC_REL14:
6188 	    case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6189 	    case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6190 	      max_branch_offset = 1 << 15;
6191 	      break;
6192 
6193 	    case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
6194 	      if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6195 		break;
6196 	      continue;
6197 
6198 	    default:
6199 	      continue;
6200 	    }
6201 
6202 	  /* Get the value of the symbol referred to by the reloc.  */
6203 	  if (!get_sym_h (&h, &isym, &tsec, NULL, &isymbuf,
6204 			  ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info), abfd))
6205 	    goto error_return;
6206 
6207 	  if (isym != NULL)
6208 	    {
6209 	      if (tsec != NULL)
6210 		;
6211 	      else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
6212 		tsec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6213 	      else
6214 		continue;
6215 
6216 	      toff = isym->st_value;
6217 	      sym_type = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info);
6218 	    }
6219 	  else
6220 	    {
6221 	      if (tsec != NULL)
6222 		toff = h->root.u.def.value;
6223 	      else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
6224 		       || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6225 		{
6226 		  unsigned long indx;
6227 
6228 		  indx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info) - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6229 		  tsec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
6230 		  toff = bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) ? indx : 0;
6231 		}
6232 	      else
6233 		continue;
6234 
6235 	      /* If this branch is to __tls_get_addr then we may later
6236 		 optimise away the call.  We won't be needing a long-
6237 		 branch stub in that case.  */
6238 	      if (bfd_link_executable (link_info)
6239 		  && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6240 		  && irel != internal_relocs)
6241 		{
6242 		  unsigned long t_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel[-1].r_info);
6243 		  unsigned long t_rtype = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[-1].r_info);
6244 		  unsigned int tls_mask = 0;
6245 
6246 		  /* The previous reloc should be one of R_PPC_TLSGD or
6247 		     R_PPC_TLSLD, or for older object files, a reloc
6248 		     on the __tls_get_addr arg setup insn.  Get tls
6249 		     mask bits from the symbol on that reloc.  */
6250 		  if (t_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
6251 		    {
6252 		      bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6253 
6254 		      if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
6255 			{
6256 			  struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6257 			    (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6258 			  char *lgot_masks = (char *)
6259 			    (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6260 			  tls_mask = lgot_masks[t_symndx];
6261 			}
6262 		    }
6263 		  else
6264 		    {
6265 		      struct elf_link_hash_entry *th
6266 			= elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[t_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
6267 
6268 		      while (th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6269 			     || th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6270 			th = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) th->root.u.i.link;
6271 
6272 		      tls_mask
6273 			= ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) th)->tls_mask;
6274 		    }
6275 
6276 		  /* The mask bits tell us if the call will be
6277 		     optimised away.  */
6278 		  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
6279 		      && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSGD
6280 			  || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16
6281 			  || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO))
6282 		    continue;
6283 		  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
6284 		      && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSLD
6285 			  || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16
6286 			  || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO))
6287 		    continue;
6288 		}
6289 
6290 	      sym_type = h->type;
6291 	    }
6292 
6293 	  if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
6294 	    {
6295 	      if (h != NULL
6296 		  && !h->def_regular
6297 		  && h->protected_def
6298 		  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
6299 		  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo)
6300 		picfixup_size += 12;
6301 	      continue;
6302 	    }
6303 
6304 	  /* The condition here under which we call find_plt_ent must
6305 	     match that in relocate_section.  If we call find_plt_ent here
6306 	     but not in relocate_section, or vice versa, then the branch
6307 	     destination used here may be incorrect.  */
6308 	  plist = NULL;
6309 	  if (h != NULL)
6310 	    {
6311 	      /* We know is_branch_reloc (r_type) is true.  */
6312 	      if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6313 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6314 		plist = &h->plt.plist;
6315 	    }
6316 	  else if (sym_type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6317 		   && elf_local_got_offsets (abfd) != NULL)
6318 	    {
6319 	      bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6320 	      struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6321 		(local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6322 	      plist = local_plt + ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info);
6323 	    }
6324 	  if (plist != NULL)
6325 	    {
6326 	      bfd_vma addend = 0;
6327 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
6328 
6329 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24 && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6330 		addend = irel->r_addend;
6331 	      ent = find_plt_ent (plist, got2, addend);
6332 	      if (ent != NULL)
6333 		{
6334 		  if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
6335 		      || h == NULL
6336 		      || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
6337 		      || h->dynindx == -1)
6338 		    {
6339 		      tsec = htab->glink;
6340 		      toff = ent->glink_offset;
6341 		    }
6342 		  else
6343 		    {
6344 		      tsec = htab->elf.splt;
6345 		      toff = ent->plt.offset;
6346 		    }
6347 		}
6348 	    }
6349 
6350 	  /* If the branch and target are in the same section, you have
6351 	     no hope of adding stubs.  We'll error out later should the
6352 	     branch overflow.  */
6353 	  if (tsec == isec)
6354 	    continue;
6355 
6356 	  /* toff is used for the symbol index when the symbol is
6357 	     undefined and we're doing a relocatable link, so we can't
6358 	     support addends.  It would be possible to do so by
6359 	     putting the addend in one_branch_fixup but addends on
6360 	     branches are rare so it hardly seems worth supporting.  */
6361 	  if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6362 	      && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr
6363 	      && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24
6364 	      && irel->r_addend != 0)
6365 	    continue;
6366 
6367 	  /* There probably isn't any reason to handle symbols in
6368 	     SEC_MERGE sections;  SEC_MERGE doesn't seem a likely
6369 	     attribute for a code section, and we are only looking at
6370 	     branches.  However, implement it correctly here as a
6371 	     reference for other target relax_section functions.  */
6372 	  if (0 && tsec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
6373 	    {
6374 	      /* At this stage in linking, no SEC_MERGE symbol has been
6375 		 adjusted, so all references to such symbols need to be
6376 		 passed through _bfd_merged_section_offset.  (Later, in
6377 		 relocate_section, all SEC_MERGE symbols *except* for
6378 		 section symbols have been adjusted.)
6379 
6380 		 gas may reduce relocations against symbols in SEC_MERGE
6381 		 sections to a relocation against the section symbol when
6382 		 the original addend was zero.  When the reloc is against
6383 		 a section symbol we should include the addend in the
6384 		 offset passed to _bfd_merged_section_offset, since the
6385 		 location of interest is the original symbol.  On the
6386 		 other hand, an access to "sym+addend" where "sym" is not
6387 		 a section symbol should not include the addend;  Such an
6388 		 access is presumed to be an offset from "sym";  The
6389 		 location of interest is just "sym".  */
6390 	      if (sym_type == STT_SECTION
6391 		  && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6392 		toff += irel->r_addend;
6393 
6394 	      toff
6395 		= _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, &tsec,
6396 					      elf_section_data (tsec)->sec_info,
6397 					      toff);
6398 
6399 	      if (sym_type != STT_SECTION
6400 		  && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6401 		toff += irel->r_addend;
6402 	    }
6403 	  /* PLTREL24 addends are special.  */
6404 	  else if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6405 	    toff += irel->r_addend;
6406 
6407 	  /* Attempted -shared link of non-pic code loses.  */
6408 	  if ((!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6409 	       && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr)
6410 	      || tsec->output_section == NULL
6411 	      || (tsec->owner != NULL
6412 		  && (tsec->owner->flags & BFD_PLUGIN) != 0))
6413 	    continue;
6414 
6415 	  roff = irel->r_offset;
6416 
6417 	  /* Avoid creating a lot of unnecessary fixups when
6418 	     relocatable if the output section size is such that a
6419 	     fixup can be created at final link.
6420 	     The max_branch_offset adjustment allows for some number
6421 	     of other fixups being needed at final link.  */
6422 	  if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6423 	      && (isec->output_section->rawsize - (isec->output_offset + roff)
6424 		  < max_branch_offset - (max_branch_offset >> 4)))
6425 	    continue;
6426 
6427 	  /* If the branch is in range, no need to do anything.  */
6428 	  if (tsec != bfd_und_section_ptr
6429 	      && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6430 		  /* A relocatable link may have sections moved during
6431 		     final link, so do not presume they remain in range.  */
6432 		  || tsec->output_section == isec->output_section))
6433 	    {
6434 	      bfd_vma symaddr, reladdr;
6435 
6436 	      symaddr = tsec->output_section->vma + tsec->output_offset + toff;
6437 	      reladdr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset + roff;
6438 	      if (symaddr - reladdr + max_branch_offset
6439 		  < 2 * max_branch_offset)
6440 		continue;
6441 	    }
6442 
6443 	  /* Look for an existing fixup to this address.  */
6444 	  for (f = branch_fixups; f ; f = f->next)
6445 	    if (f->tsec == tsec && f->toff == toff)
6446 	      break;
6447 
6448 	  if (f == NULL)
6449 	    {
6450 	      size_t size;
6451 	      unsigned long stub_rtype;
6452 
6453 	      val = trampoff - roff;
6454 	      if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6455 		/* Oh dear, we can't reach a trampoline.  Don't try to add
6456 		   one.  We'll report an error later.  */
6457 		continue;
6458 
6459 	      if (bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6460 		{
6461 		  size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry);
6462 		  insn_offset = 12;
6463 		}
6464 	      else
6465 		{
6466 		  size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
6467 		  insn_offset = 0;
6468 		}
6469 	      stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX;
6470 	      if (tsec == htab->elf.splt
6471 		  || tsec == htab->glink)
6472 		{
6473 		  stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLT;
6474 		  if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6475 		    stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24;
6476 		}
6477 
6478 	      /* Hijack the old relocation.  Since we need two
6479 		 relocations for this use a "composite" reloc.  */
6480 	      irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info),
6481 					   stub_rtype);
6482 	      irel->r_offset = trampoff + insn_offset;
6483 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
6484 		  && stub_rtype != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
6485 		irel->r_addend = 0;
6486 
6487 	      /* Record the fixup so we don't do it again this section.  */
6488 	      f = bfd_malloc (sizeof (*f));
6489 	      f->next = branch_fixups;
6490 	      f->tsec = tsec;
6491 	      f->toff = toff;
6492 	      f->trampoff = trampoff;
6493 	      branch_fixups = f;
6494 
6495 	      trampoff += size;
6496 	      changes++;
6497 	    }
6498 	  else
6499 	    {
6500 	      val = f->trampoff - roff;
6501 	      if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6502 		continue;
6503 
6504 	      /* Nop out the reloc, since we're finalizing things here.  */
6505 	      irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6506 	    }
6507 
6508 	  /* Get the section contents.  */
6509 	  if (contents == NULL)
6510 	    {
6511 	      /* Get cached copy if it exists.  */
6512 	      if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
6513 		contents = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents;
6514 	      /* Go get them off disk.  */
6515 	      else if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, isec, &contents))
6516 		goto error_return;
6517 	    }
6518 
6519 	  /* Fix up the existing branch to hit the trampoline.  */
6520 	  hit_addr = contents + roff;
6521 	  switch (r_type)
6522 	    {
6523 	    case R_PPC_REL24:
6524 	    case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6525 	    case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6526 	      t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6527 	      t0 &= ~0x3fffffc;
6528 	      t0 |= val & 0x3fffffc;
6529 	      bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6530 	      break;
6531 
6532 	    case R_PPC_REL14:
6533 	    case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6534 	    case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6535 	      t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6536 	      t0 &= ~0xfffc;
6537 	      t0 |= val & 0xfffc;
6538 	      bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6539 	      break;
6540 	    }
6541 	}
6542 
6543       while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6544 	{
6545 	  struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6546 	  branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6547 	  free (f);
6548 	}
6549     }
6550 
6551   workaround_change = false;
6552   newsize = trampoff;
6553   if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6554       && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6555 	  || isec->output_section->alignment_power >= htab->params->pagesize_p2))
6556     {
6557       bfd_vma addr, end_addr;
6558       unsigned int crossings;
6559       bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6560 
6561       addr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset;
6562       end_addr = addr + trampoff;
6563       addr &= -pagesize;
6564       crossings = ((end_addr & -pagesize) - addr) >> htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6565       if (crossings != 0)
6566 	{
6567 	  /* Keep space aligned, to ensure the patch code itself does
6568 	     not cross a page.  Don't decrease size calculated on a
6569 	     previous pass as otherwise we might never settle on a layout.  */
6570 	  newsize = 15 - ((end_addr - 1) & 15);
6571 	  newsize += crossings * 16;
6572 	  if (relax_info->workaround_size < newsize)
6573 	    {
6574 	      relax_info->workaround_size = newsize;
6575 	      workaround_change = true;
6576 	    }
6577 	  /* Ensure relocate_section is called.  */
6578 	  isec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
6579 	}
6580       newsize = trampoff + relax_info->workaround_size;
6581     }
6582 
6583   if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6584     {
6585       picfixup_size -= relax_info->picfixup_size;
6586       if (picfixup_size != 0)
6587 	relax_info->picfixup_size += picfixup_size;
6588       newsize += relax_info->picfixup_size;
6589     }
6590 
6591   if (changes != 0 || picfixup_size != 0 || workaround_change)
6592     isec->size = newsize;
6593 
6594   if (isymbuf != NULL
6595       && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) isymbuf)
6596     {
6597       if (! link_info->keep_memory)
6598 	free (isymbuf);
6599       else
6600 	{
6601 	  /* Cache the symbols for elf_link_input_bfd.  */
6602 	  symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf;
6603 	}
6604     }
6605 
6606   if (contents != NULL
6607       && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6608     {
6609       if (!changes && !link_info->keep_memory)
6610 	free (contents);
6611       else
6612 	{
6613 	  /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd.  */
6614 	  elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
6615 	}
6616     }
6617 
6618   changes += picfixup_size;
6619   if (changes != 0)
6620     {
6621       /* Append sufficient NOP relocs so we can write out relocation
6622 	 information for the trampolines.  */
6623       Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
6624       Elf_Internal_Rela *new_relocs = bfd_malloc ((changes + isec->reloc_count)
6625 						  * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6626       unsigned ix;
6627 
6628       if (!new_relocs)
6629 	goto error_return;
6630       memcpy (new_relocs, internal_relocs,
6631 	      isec->reloc_count * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6632       for (ix = changes; ix--;)
6633 	{
6634 	  irel = new_relocs + ix + isec->reloc_count;
6635 
6636 	  irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6637 	}
6638       if (internal_relocs != elf_section_data (isec)->relocs)
6639 	free (internal_relocs);
6640       elf_section_data (isec)->relocs = new_relocs;
6641       isec->reloc_count += changes;
6642       rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (isec);
6643       rel_hdr->sh_size += changes * rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
6644     }
6645   else if (elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6646     free (internal_relocs);
6647 
6648   *again = changes != 0 || workaround_change;
6649   return true;
6650 
6651  error_return:
6652   while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6653     {
6654       struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6655       branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6656       free (f);
6657     }
6658   if ((unsigned char *) isymbuf != symtab_hdr->contents)
6659     free (isymbuf);
6660   if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6661     free (contents);
6662   if (elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6663     free (internal_relocs);
6664   return false;
6665 }
6666 
6667 /* What to do when ld finds relocations against symbols defined in
6668    discarded sections.  */
6669 
6670 static unsigned int
ppc_elf_action_discarded(asection * sec)6671 ppc_elf_action_discarded (asection *sec)
6672 {
6673   if (strcmp (".fixup", sec->name) == 0)
6674     return 0;
6675 
6676   if (strcmp (".got2", sec->name) == 0)
6677     return 0;
6678 
6679   return _bfd_elf_default_action_discarded (sec);
6680 }
6681 
6682 /* Fill in the address for a pointer generated in a linker section.  */
6683 
6684 static bfd_vma
elf_finish_pointer_linker_section(bfd * input_bfd,elf_linker_section_t * lsect,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,bfd_vma relocation,const Elf_Internal_Rela * rel)6685 elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (bfd *input_bfd,
6686 				   elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
6687 				   struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6688 				   bfd_vma relocation,
6689 				   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
6690 {
6691   elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
6692 
6693   BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
6694 
6695   if (h != NULL)
6696     {
6697       /* Handle global symbol.  */
6698       struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
6699 
6700       eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6701       BFD_ASSERT (eh->elf.def_regular);
6702       linker_section_ptr = eh->linker_section_pointer;
6703     }
6704   else
6705     {
6706       /* Handle local symbol.  */
6707       unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
6708 
6709       BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (input_bfd));
6710       BFD_ASSERT (elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd) != NULL);
6711       linker_section_ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd)[r_symndx];
6712     }
6713 
6714   linker_section_ptr = elf_find_pointer_linker_section (linker_section_ptr,
6715 							rel->r_addend,
6716 							lsect);
6717   BFD_ASSERT (linker_section_ptr != NULL);
6718 
6719   /* Offset will always be a multiple of four, so use the bottom bit
6720      as a "written" flag.  */
6721   if ((linker_section_ptr->offset & 1) == 0)
6722     {
6723       bfd_put_32 (lsect->section->owner,
6724 		  relocation + linker_section_ptr->addend,
6725 		  lsect->section->contents + linker_section_ptr->offset);
6726       linker_section_ptr->offset += 1;
6727     }
6728 
6729   relocation = (lsect->section->output_section->vma
6730 		+ lsect->section->output_offset
6731 		+ linker_section_ptr->offset - 1
6732 		- SYM_VAL (lsect->sym));
6733 
6734 #ifdef DEBUG
6735   fprintf (stderr,
6736 	   "Finish pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld (0x%lx)\n",
6737 	   lsect->name, (long) relocation, (long) relocation);
6738 #endif
6739 
6740   return relocation;
6741 }
6742 
6743 #define PPC_LO(v) ((v) & 0xffff)
6744 #define PPC_HI(v) (((v) >> 16) & 0xffff)
6745 #define PPC_HA(v) PPC_HI ((v) + 0x8000)
6746 
6747 static void
write_glink_stub(struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,struct plt_entry * ent,asection * plt_sec,unsigned char * p,struct bfd_link_info * info)6748 write_glink_stub (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, struct plt_entry *ent,
6749 		  asection *plt_sec, unsigned char *p,
6750 		  struct bfd_link_info *info)
6751 {
6752   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6753   bfd *output_bfd = info->output_bfd;
6754   bfd_vma plt;
6755   unsigned char *end = p + GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
6756 
6757   if (h != NULL
6758       && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6759       && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
6760     {
6761       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_3, p);
6762       p += 4;
6763       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_3 + 4, p);
6764       p += 4;
6765       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_0_3, p);
6766       p += 4;
6767       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, CMPWI_11_0, p);
6768       p += 4;
6769       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_3_12_2, p);
6770       p += 4;
6771       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BEQLR, p);
6772       p += 4;
6773       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_3_0, p);
6774       p += 4;
6775       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
6776       p += 4;
6777     }
6778 
6779   plt = ((ent->plt.offset & ~1)
6780 	 + plt_sec->output_section->vma
6781 	 + plt_sec->output_offset);
6782 
6783   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
6784     {
6785       bfd_vma got = 0;
6786 
6787       if (ent->addend >= 32768)
6788 	got = (ent->addend
6789 	       + ent->sec->output_section->vma
6790 	       + ent->sec->output_offset);
6791       else if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
6792 	got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
6793 
6794       plt -= got;
6795 
6796       if (plt + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
6797 	bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_30 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6798       else
6799 	{
6800 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_30 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6801 	  p += 4;
6802 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6803 	}
6804     }
6805   else
6806     {
6807       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_11 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6808       p += 4;
6809       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6810     }
6811   p += 4;
6812   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_11, p);
6813   p += 4;
6814   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
6815   p += 4;
6816   while (p < end)
6817     {
6818       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
6819       p += 4;
6820     }
6821 }
6822 
6823 /* Return true if symbol is defined statically.  */
6824 
6825 static bool
is_static_defined(struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)6826 is_static_defined (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6827 {
6828   return ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6829 	   || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6830 	  && h->root.u.def.section != NULL
6831 	  && h->root.u.def.section->output_section != NULL);
6832 }
6833 
6834 /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tls operand, return
6835    the transformed insn for TLS optimisation, otherwise return 0.  If
6836    REG is non-zero only match an insn with RB or RA equal to REG.  */
6837 
6838 unsigned int
_bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform(unsigned int insn,unsigned int reg)6839 _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6840 {
6841   unsigned int rtra;
6842 
6843   if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) != 31 << 26)
6844     return 0;
6845 
6846   if (reg == 0 || ((insn >> 11) & 0x1f) == reg)
6847     rtra = insn & ((1 << 26) - (1 << 16));
6848   else if (((insn >> 16) & 0x1f) == reg)
6849     rtra = (insn & (0x1f << 21)) | ((insn & (0x1f << 11)) << 5);
6850   else
6851     return 0;
6852 
6853   if ((insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == 266 << 1)
6854     /* add -> addi.  */
6855     insn = 14 << 26;
6856   else if ((insn & (0x1f << 1)) == 23 << 1
6857 	   && ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 14 << 6
6858 	       || ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) >= 16 << 6
6859 		   && (insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 24 << 6)))
6860     /* load and store indexed -> dform.  */
6861     insn = (32u | ((insn >> 6) & 0x1f)) << 26;
6862   else if ((insn & (((0x1a << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 21 << 1)
6863     /* ldx, ldux, stdx, stdux -> ld, ldu, std, stdu.  */
6864     insn = ((58u | ((insn >> 6) & 4)) << 26) | ((insn >> 6) & 1);
6865   else if ((insn & (((0x1f << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 341 << 1)
6866     /* lwax -> lwa.  */
6867     insn = (58u << 26) | 2;
6868   else
6869     return 0;
6870   insn |= rtra;
6871   return insn;
6872 }
6873 
6874 /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tprel operand, return
6875    the transformed insn for an undefined weak symbol, ie. with the
6876    thread pointer REG operand removed.  Otherwise return 0.  */
6877 
6878 unsigned int
_bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform(unsigned int insn,unsigned int reg)6879 _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6880 {
6881   if ((insn & (0x1f << 16)) == reg << 16
6882       && ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
6883 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 15u << 26 /* addis */
6884 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
6885 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
6886 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
6887 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
6888 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
6889 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
6890 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
6891 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
6892 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
6893 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
6894 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
6895 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
6896 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
6897 	  || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
6898 	      && (insn & 3) != 1)
6899 	  || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
6900 	      && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3))))
6901     {
6902       insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
6903     }
6904   else if ((insn & (0x1f << 21)) == reg << 21
6905 	   && ((insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori, oris */
6906 	       || (insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */
6907 	       || (insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi,andis */))
6908     {
6909       insn &= ~(0x1f << 21);
6910       insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 16)) << 5;
6911       if ((insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */)
6912 	insn -= 2 >> 26;  /* convert to ori,oris */
6913     }
6914   else
6915     insn = 0;
6916   return insn;
6917 }
6918 
6919 static bool
is_insn_ds_form(unsigned int insn)6920 is_insn_ds_form (unsigned int insn)
6921 {
6922   return ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* ld,ldu,lwa */
6923 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std,stdu,stq */
6924 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 57u << 26 /* lfdp */
6925 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 61u << 26 /* stfdp */);
6926 }
6927 
6928 static bool
is_insn_dq_form(unsigned int insn)6929 is_insn_dq_form (unsigned int insn)
6930 {
6931   return ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 56u << 26 /* lq */
6932 	  || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (61u << 26) /* lxv, stxv */
6933 	      && (insn & 3) == 1));
6934 }
6935 
6936 /* The RELOCATE_SECTION function is called by the ELF backend linker
6937    to handle the relocations for a section.
6938 
6939    The relocs are always passed as Rela structures; if the section
6940    actually uses Rel structures, the r_addend field will always be
6941    zero.
6942 
6943    This function is responsible for adjust the section contents as
6944    necessary, and (if using Rela relocs and generating a
6945    relocatable output file) adjusting the reloc addend as
6946    necessary.
6947 
6948    This function does not have to worry about setting the reloc
6949    address or the reloc symbol index.
6950 
6951    LOCAL_SYMS is a pointer to the swapped in local symbols.
6952 
6953    LOCAL_SECTIONS is an array giving the section in the input file
6954    corresponding to the st_shndx field of each local symbol.
6955 
6956    The global hash table entry for the global symbols can be found
6957    via elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd).
6958 
6959    When generating relocatable output, this function must handle
6960    STB_LOCAL/STT_SECTION symbols specially.  The output symbol is
6961    going to be the section symbol corresponding to the output
6962    section, which means that the addend must be adjusted
6963    accordingly.  */
6964 
6965 static int
ppc_elf_relocate_section(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd * input_bfd,asection * input_section,bfd_byte * contents,Elf_Internal_Rela * relocs,Elf_Internal_Sym * local_syms,asection ** local_sections)6966 ppc_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd,
6967 			  struct bfd_link_info *info,
6968 			  bfd *input_bfd,
6969 			  asection *input_section,
6970 			  bfd_byte *contents,
6971 			  Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
6972 			  Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
6973 			  asection **local_sections)
6974 {
6975   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6976   struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
6977   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6978   Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
6979   Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
6980   Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
6981   Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
6982   asection *got2;
6983   bfd_vma *local_got_offsets;
6984   bool ret = true;
6985   bfd_vma d_offset = (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd) ? 2 : 0);
6986   bool is_vxworks_tls;
6987   unsigned int picfixup_size = 0;
6988   struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
6989 
6990 #ifdef DEBUG
6991   _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_relocate_section called for %pB section %pA, "
6992 		      "%ld relocations%s",
6993 		      input_bfd, input_section,
6994 		      (long) input_section->reloc_count,
6995 		      (bfd_link_relocatable (info)) ? " (relocatable)" : "");
6996 #endif
6997 
6998   if (!is_ppc_elf (input_bfd))
6999     {
7000       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
7001       return false;
7002     }
7003 
7004   got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (input_bfd, ".got2");
7005 
7006   /* Initialize howto table if not already done.  */
7007   if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
7008     ppc_elf_howto_init ();
7009 
7010   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
7011   local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (input_bfd);
7012   symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
7013   sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
7014   /* We have to handle relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections
7015      specially, because the dynamic loader is 'weird'.  */
7016   is_vxworks_tls = (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks && bfd_link_pic (info)
7017 		    && !strcmp (input_section->output_section->name,
7018 				".tls_vars"));
7019   if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET)
7020     relax_info = elf_section_data (input_section)->sec_info;
7021   rel = wrel = relocs;
7022   relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
7023   for (; rel < relend; wrel++, rel++)
7024     {
7025       enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
7026       bfd_vma addend;
7027       bfd_reloc_status_type r;
7028       Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7029       asection *sec;
7030       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7031       const char *sym_name;
7032       reloc_howto_type *howto;
7033       unsigned long r_symndx;
7034       bfd_vma relocation;
7035       bfd_vma branch_bit, from;
7036       bool unresolved_reloc, save_unresolved_reloc;
7037       bool warned;
7038       unsigned int tls_type, tls_mask, tls_gd;
7039       struct plt_entry **ifunc, **plt_list;
7040       struct reloc_howto_struct alt_howto;
7041 
7042     again:
7043       r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
7044       sym = NULL;
7045       sec = NULL;
7046       h = NULL;
7047       unresolved_reloc = false;
7048       warned = false;
7049       r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7050 
7051       if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7052 	{
7053 	  sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
7054 	  sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
7055 	  sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, sym, sec);
7056 
7057 	  relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
7058 	}
7059       else
7060 	{
7061 	  bool ignored;
7062 
7063 	  RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
7064 				   r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
7065 				   h, sec, relocation,
7066 				   unresolved_reloc, warned, ignored);
7067 
7068 	  sym_name = h->root.root.string;
7069 	}
7070 
7071       if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
7072 	{
7073 	  /* For relocs against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
7074 	     or sections discarded by a linker script, we just want the
7075 	     section contents zeroed.  Avoid any special processing.  */
7076 	  howto = NULL;
7077 	  if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7078 	    howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7079 
7080 	  _bfd_clear_contents (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
7081 			       contents, rel->r_offset);
7082 	  wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset;
7083 	  wrel->r_info = 0;
7084 	  wrel->r_addend = 0;
7085 
7086 	  /* For ld -r, remove relocations in debug sections against
7087 	     symbols defined in discarded sections.  Not done for
7088 	     non-debug to preserve relocs in .eh_frame which the
7089 	     eh_frame editing code expects to be present.  */
7090 	  if (bfd_link_relocatable (info)
7091 	      && (input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
7092 	    wrel--;
7093 
7094 	  continue;
7095 	}
7096 
7097       if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
7098 	{
7099 	  if (got2 != NULL
7100 	      && r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7101 	      && rel->r_addend != 0)
7102 	    {
7103 	      /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special.  If non-zero, the
7104 		 addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2.  */
7105 	      rel->r_addend += got2->output_offset;
7106 	    }
7107 	  if (r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLT
7108 	      && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24
7109 	      && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX)
7110 	    goto copy_reloc;
7111 	}
7112 
7113       /* TLS optimizations.  Replace instruction sequences and relocs
7114 	 based on information we collected in tls_optimize.  We edit
7115 	 RELOCS so that --emit-relocs will output something sensible
7116 	 for the final instruction stream.  */
7117       tls_mask = 0;
7118       tls_gd = 0;
7119       if (h != NULL)
7120 	tls_mask = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_mask;
7121       else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
7122 	{
7123 	  struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7124 	  char *lgot_masks;
7125 	  local_plt
7126 	    = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7127 	  lgot_masks = (char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7128 	  tls_mask = lgot_masks[r_symndx];
7129 	}
7130 
7131       /* Ensure reloc mapping code below stays sane.  */
7132       if ((R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3)    != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)
7133 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO & 3)
7134 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI & 3)
7135 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA & 3)
7136 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3)    != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16 & 3)
7137 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO & 3)
7138 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI & 3)
7139 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA & 3))
7140 	abort ();
7141       switch (r_type)
7142 	{
7143 	default:
7144 	  break;
7145 
7146 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7147 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7148 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7149 	      && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0
7150 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7151 	    {
7152 	      bfd_vma insn;
7153 
7154 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7155 				 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7156 	      insn &= 31 << 21;
7157 	      insn |= 0x3c020000;	/* addis 0,2,0 */
7158 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7159 			  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7160 	      r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7161 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7162 	    }
7163 	  break;
7164 
7165 	case R_PPC_TLS:
7166 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7167 	      && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0
7168 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
7169 	    {
7170 	      bfd_vma insn;
7171 
7172 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7173 	      insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (insn, 2);
7174 	      if (insn == 0)
7175 		abort ();
7176 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7177 	      r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7178 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7179 
7180 	      /* Was PPC_TLS which sits on insn boundary, now
7181 		 PPC_TPREL16_LO which is at low-order half-word.  */
7182 	      rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7183 	    }
7184 	  break;
7185 
7186 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7187 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7188 	  tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
7189 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
7190 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7191 	    goto tls_gdld_hi;
7192 	  break;
7193 
7194 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7195 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7196 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
7197 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7198 	    {
7199 	    tls_gdld_hi:
7200 	      if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7201 		r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7202 			  + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7203 	      else
7204 		{
7205 		  rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
7206 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7207 		  r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7208 		}
7209 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7210 	    }
7211 	  break;
7212 
7213 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7214 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7215 	  tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
7216 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
7217 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7218 	    goto tls_ldgd_opt;
7219 	  break;
7220 
7221 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7222 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7223 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
7224 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7225 	    {
7226 	      unsigned int insn1, insn2;
7227 	      bfd_vma offset;
7228 
7229 	    tls_ldgd_opt:
7230 	      offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
7231 	      /* If not using the newer R_PPC_TLSGD/LD to mark
7232 		 __tls_get_addr calls, we must trust that the call
7233 		 stays with its arg setup insns, ie. that the next
7234 		 reloc is the __tls_get_addr call associated with
7235 		 the current reloc.  Edit both insns.  */
7236 	      if (input_section->nomark_tls_get_addr
7237 		  && rel + 1 < relend
7238 		  && branch_reloc_hash_match (input_bfd, rel + 1,
7239 					      htab->tls_get_addr))
7240 		offset = rel[1].r_offset;
7241 	      /* We read the low GOT_TLS insn because we need to keep
7242 		 the destination reg.  It may be something other than
7243 		 the usual r3, and moved to r3 before the call by
7244 		 intervening code.  */
7245 	      insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7246 				  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7247 	      if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7248 		{
7249 		  /* IE */
7250 		  insn1 &= (0x1f << 21) | (0x1f << 16);
7251 		  insn1 |= 32u << 26;	/* lwz */
7252 		  if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1
7253 		      && offset_in_range (input_section, offset, 4))
7254 		    {
7255 		      rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7256 		      insn2 = 0x7c631214;	/* add 3,3,2 */
7257 		      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7258 		    }
7259 		  r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7260 			    + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7261 		  rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7262 		}
7263 	      else
7264 		{
7265 		  /* LE */
7266 		  insn1 &= 0x1f << 21;
7267 		  insn1 |= 0x3c020000;	/* addis r,2,0 */
7268 		  if (tls_gd == 0)
7269 		    {
7270 		      /* Was an LD reloc.  */
7271 		      for (r_symndx = 0;
7272 			   r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7273 			   r_symndx++)
7274 			if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7275 			  break;
7276 		      if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7277 			r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7278 		      rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7279 		      if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7280 			rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7281 					  + sec->output_offset
7282 					  + sec->output_section->vma);
7283 		    }
7284 		  r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7285 		  rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7286 		  if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1
7287 		      && offset_in_range (input_section, offset, 4))
7288 		    {
7289 		      rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7290 		      rel[1].r_offset = offset + d_offset;
7291 		      rel[1].r_addend = rel->r_addend;
7292 		      insn2 = 0x38630000;	/* addi 3,3,0 */
7293 		      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7294 		    }
7295 		}
7296 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn1,
7297 			  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7298 	      if (tls_gd == 0)
7299 		{
7300 		  /* We changed the symbol on an LD reloc.  Start over
7301 		     in order to get h, sym, sec etc. right.  */
7302 		  goto again;
7303 		}
7304 	    }
7305 	  break;
7306 
7307 	case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7308 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
7309 	      && rel + 1 < relend
7310 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
7311 	    {
7312 	      unsigned int insn2;
7313 	      bfd_vma offset = rel->r_offset;
7314 
7315 	      if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7316 		{
7317 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
7318 		  rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7319 		  break;
7320 		}
7321 
7322 	      if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0)
7323 		{
7324 		  /* IE */
7325 		  r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7326 		  insn2 = 0x7c631214;	/* add 3,3,2 */
7327 		}
7328 	      else
7329 		{
7330 		  /* LE */
7331 		  r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7332 		  rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7333 		  insn2 = 0x38630000;	/* addi 3,3,0 */
7334 		}
7335 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7336 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7337 	      /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too.  */
7338 	      BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7339 	      rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7340 	    }
7341 	  break;
7342 
7343 	case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7344 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
7345 	      && rel + 1 < relend
7346 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
7347 	    {
7348 	      unsigned int insn2;
7349 
7350 	      if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7351 		{
7352 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7353 		  rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7354 		  break;
7355 		}
7356 
7357 	      for (r_symndx = 0;
7358 		   r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7359 		   r_symndx++)
7360 		if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7361 		  break;
7362 	      if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7363 		r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7364 	      rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7365 	      if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7366 		rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7367 				  + sec->output_offset
7368 				  + sec->output_section->vma);
7369 
7370 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7371 	      rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7372 	      insn2 = 0x38630000;	/* addi 3,3,0 */
7373 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2,
7374 			  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7375 	      /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too.  */
7376 	      BFD_ASSERT (rel->r_offset - d_offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7377 	      rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7378 	      goto again;
7379 	    }
7380 	  break;
7381 	}
7382 
7383       /* Handle other relocations that tweak non-addend part of insn.  */
7384       branch_bit = 0;
7385       switch (r_type)
7386 	{
7387 	default:
7388 	  break;
7389 
7390 	  /* Branch taken prediction relocations.  */
7391 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
7392 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
7393 	  branch_bit = BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7394 	  /* Fall through.  */
7395 
7396 	  /* Branch not taken prediction relocations.  */
7397 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
7398 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
7399 	  if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
7400 	    {
7401 	      unsigned int insn;
7402 
7403 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7404 	      insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7405 	      insn |= branch_bit;
7406 
7407 	      from = (rel->r_offset
7408 		      + input_section->output_offset
7409 		      + input_section->output_section->vma);
7410 
7411 	      /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default.  */
7412 	      if ((bfd_signed_vma) (relocation + rel->r_addend - from) < 0)
7413 		insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7414 
7415 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7416 	    }
7417 	  break;
7418 
7419 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
7420 	  if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7421 	    {
7422 	      unsigned int insn;
7423 
7424 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7425 				 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7426 	      if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 15u << 26
7427 		  && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) != 0)
7428 		{
7429 		  if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
7430 		    {
7431 		      /* Convert addis to lis.  */
7432 		      insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
7433 		      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7434 				  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7435 		    }
7436 		}
7437 	      else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
7438 		info->callbacks->einfo
7439 		  (_("%P: %H: error: %s with unexpected instruction %x\n"),
7440 		   input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7441 		   "R_PPC_PLT16_HA", insn);
7442 	    }
7443 	  break;
7444 	}
7445 
7446       if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
7447 	  && h != NULL
7448 	  && !h->def_regular
7449 	  && h->protected_def
7450 	  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
7451 	  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
7452 	  && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
7453 	{
7454 	  /* Convert lis;addi or lis;load/store accessing a protected
7455 	     variable defined in a shared library to PIC.  */
7456 	  unsigned int insn;
7457 
7458 	  if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA
7459 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7460 	    {
7461 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7462 				 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7463 	      if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (15u << 26)
7464 		  && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) == 0 /* lis */)
7465 		{
7466 		  bfd_byte *p;
7467 		  bfd_vma off;
7468 		  bfd_vma got_addr;
7469 
7470 		  p = (contents + input_section->size
7471 		       - relax_info->workaround_size
7472 		       - relax_info->picfixup_size
7473 		       + picfixup_size);
7474 		  off = (p - contents) - (rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7475 		  if (off > 0x1fffffc || (off & 3) != 0)
7476 		    info->callbacks->einfo
7477 		      (_("%H: fixup branch overflow\n"),
7478 		       input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
7479 
7480 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | off,
7481 			      contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7482 		  got_addr = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7483 			      + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7484 			      + (h->got.offset & ~1));
7485 		  wrel->r_offset = (p - contents) + d_offset;
7486 		  wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
7487 		  wrel->r_addend = got_addr;
7488 		  insn &= ~0xffff;
7489 		  insn |= ((unsigned int) (got_addr + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
7490 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
7491 
7492 		  /* Convert lis to lwz, loading address from GOT.  */
7493 		  insn &= ~0xffff;
7494 		  insn ^= (32u ^ 15u) << 26;
7495 		  insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 21)) >> 5;
7496 		  insn |= got_addr & 0xffff;
7497 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p + 4);
7498 
7499 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | ((-4 - off) & 0x3ffffff), p + 8);
7500 		  picfixup_size += 12;
7501 
7502 		  /* Use one of the spare relocs, so --emit-relocs
7503 		     output is reasonable.  */
7504 		  memmove (rel + 1, rel, (relend - rel - 1) * sizeof (*rel));
7505 		  wrel++, rel++;
7506 		  rel->r_offset = wrel[-1].r_offset + 4;
7507 		  rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
7508 		  rel->r_addend = wrel[-1].r_addend;
7509 
7510 		  /* Continue on as if we had a got reloc, to output
7511 		     dynamic reloc.  */
7512 		  r_type = R_PPC_GOT16_LO;
7513 		}
7514 	      else
7515 		_bfd_error_handler
7516 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
7517 		  (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7518 		     "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7519 		   input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7520 		   "R_PPC_ADDR16_HA", insn);
7521 	    }
7522 	  else if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO
7523 		   && offset_in_range (input_section,
7524 				       rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7525 	    {
7526 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7527 				 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7528 	      if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14u << 26    /* addi */
7529 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
7530 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
7531 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
7532 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
7533 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
7534 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
7535 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
7536 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
7537 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
7538 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
7539 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
7540 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
7541 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
7542 		  || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
7543 		      && (insn & 3) != 1)
7544 		  || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
7545 		      && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3)))
7546 		{
7547 		  /* Arrange to apply the reloc addend, if any.  */
7548 		  relocation = 0;
7549 		  unresolved_reloc = false;
7550 		  rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, r_type);
7551 		}
7552 	      else
7553 		_bfd_error_handler
7554 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
7555 		  (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7556 		     "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7557 		   input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7558 		   "R_PPC_ADDR16_LO", insn);
7559 	    }
7560 	}
7561 
7562       ifunc = NULL;
7563       if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks)
7564 	{
7565 	  struct plt_entry *ent;
7566 
7567 	  if (h != NULL)
7568 	    {
7569 	      if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7570 		ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
7571 	    }
7572 	  else if (local_got_offsets != NULL
7573 		   && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7574 	    {
7575 	      struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7576 
7577 	      local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
7578 						 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7579 	      ifunc = local_plt + r_symndx;
7580 	    }
7581 
7582 	  ent = NULL;
7583 	  if (ifunc != NULL
7584 	      && (!bfd_link_pic (info)
7585 		  || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
7586 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7587 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7588 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7589 	    {
7590 	      addend = 0;
7591 	      if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7592 		  && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7593 		      || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7594 		      || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7595 		      || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7596 		addend = rel->r_addend;
7597 	      ent = find_plt_ent (ifunc, got2, addend);
7598 	    }
7599 	  if (ent != NULL)
7600 	    {
7601 	      if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7602 		  && ent->sec != got2
7603 		  && htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW
7604 		  && (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7605 		      || h == NULL
7606 		      || h->dynindx == -1))
7607 		{
7608 		  /* Uh oh, we are going to create a pic glink stub
7609 		     for an ifunc (here for h == NULL and later in
7610 		     finish_dynamic_symbol for h != NULL), and
7611 		     apparently are using code compiled with
7612 		     -mbss-plt.  The difficulty is that -mbss-plt code
7613 		     gives no indication via a magic PLTREL24 addend
7614 		     whether r30 is equal to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or
7615 		     is pointing into a .got2 section (and how far
7616 		     into .got2).  */
7617 		    info->callbacks->einfo
7618 		      /* xgettext:c-format */
7619 		      (_("%X%H: unsupported bss-plt -fPIC ifunc %s\n"),
7620 		       input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
7621 		}
7622 
7623 	      unresolved_reloc = false;
7624 	      if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
7625 		  || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7626 		  || h == NULL
7627 		  || h->dynindx == -1)
7628 		relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
7629 			      + htab->glink->output_offset
7630 			      + (ent->glink_offset & ~1));
7631 	      else
7632 		relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
7633 			      + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
7634 			      + ent->plt.offset);
7635 	    }
7636 	}
7637 
7638       addend = rel->r_addend;
7639       save_unresolved_reloc = unresolved_reloc;
7640       howto = NULL;
7641       if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7642 	howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7643 
7644       tls_type = 0;
7645       switch (r_type)
7646 	{
7647 	default:
7648 	de_fault:
7649 	  if (howto)
7650 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
7651 	    _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
7652 				input_bfd, howto->name);
7653 	  else
7654 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
7655 	    _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: reloc %#x unsupported"),
7656 				input_bfd, r_type);
7657 
7658 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7659 	  ret = false;
7660 	  goto copy_reloc;
7661 
7662 	case R_PPC_NONE:
7663 	case R_PPC_TLS:
7664 	case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7665 	case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7666 	case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
7667 	case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
7668 	case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
7669 	  goto copy_reloc;
7670 
7671 	  /* GOT16 relocations.  Like an ADDR16 using the symbol's
7672 	     address in the GOT as relocation value instead of the
7673 	     symbol's value itself.  Also, create a GOT entry for the
7674 	     symbol and put the symbol value there.  */
7675 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7676 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7677 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7678 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7679 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7680 	  goto dogot;
7681 
7682 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7683 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7684 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7685 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7686 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7687 	  goto dogot;
7688 
7689 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7690 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7691 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
7692 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
7693 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7694 	  goto dogot;
7695 
7696 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
7697 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
7698 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
7699 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
7700 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7701 	  goto dogot;
7702 
7703 	case R_PPC_GOT16:
7704 	case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
7705 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
7706 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
7707 	  tls_mask = 0;
7708 	dogot:
7709 	  {
7710 	    /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the global
7711 	       offset table.  */
7712 	    bfd_vma off;
7713 	    bfd_vma *offp;
7714 	    unsigned long indx;
7715 
7716 	    if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
7717 	      abort ();
7718 
7719 	    indx = 0;
7720 	    if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
7721 		&& SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7722 	      offp = &htab->tlsld_got.offset;
7723 	    else if (h != NULL)
7724 	      {
7725 		if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7726 		    || h->dynindx == -1
7727 		    || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)
7728 		    || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
7729 		  /* This is actually a static link, or it is a
7730 		     -Bsymbolic link and the symbol is defined
7731 		     locally, or the symbol was forced to be local
7732 		     because of a version file.  */
7733 		  ;
7734 		else
7735 		  {
7736 		    indx = h->dynindx;
7737 		    unresolved_reloc = false;
7738 		  }
7739 		offp = &h->got.offset;
7740 	      }
7741 	    else
7742 	      {
7743 		if (local_got_offsets == NULL)
7744 		  abort ();
7745 		offp = &local_got_offsets[r_symndx];
7746 	      }
7747 
7748 	    /* The offset must always be a multiple of 4.  We use the
7749 	       least significant bit to record whether we have already
7750 	       processed this entry.  */
7751 	    off = *offp;
7752 	    if ((off & 1) != 0)
7753 	      off &= ~1;
7754 	    else
7755 	      {
7756 		unsigned int tls_m = ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7757 				      ? tls_mask & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL
7758 						    | TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)
7759 				      : 0);
7760 
7761 		if (offp == &htab->tlsld_got.offset)
7762 		  tls_m = TLS_LD;
7763 		else if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0
7764 			 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7765 		  tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7766 
7767 		/* We might have multiple got entries for this sym.
7768 		   Initialize them all.  */
7769 		do
7770 		  {
7771 		    int tls_ty = 0;
7772 
7773 		    if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0)
7774 		      {
7775 			tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7776 			tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7777 		      }
7778 		    else if ((tls_m & TLS_GD) != 0)
7779 		      {
7780 			tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7781 			tls_m &= ~TLS_GD;
7782 		      }
7783 		    else if ((tls_m & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7784 		      {
7785 			tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7786 			tls_m &= ~TLS_DTPREL;
7787 		      }
7788 		    else if ((tls_m & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
7789 		      {
7790 			tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7791 			tls_m = 0;
7792 		      }
7793 
7794 		    /* Generate relocs for the dynamic linker.  */
7795 		    if (indx != 0
7796 			|| (bfd_link_pic (info)
7797 			    && (h == NULL
7798 				|| !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
7799 			    && !(tls_ty != 0
7800 				 && bfd_link_executable (info)
7801 				 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7802 			    && (h != NULL
7803 				? !bfd_is_abs_symbol (&h->root)
7804 				: sym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)))
7805 		      {
7806 			asection *rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
7807 			bfd_byte * loc;
7808 
7809 			if (ifunc != NULL)
7810 			  {
7811 			    rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
7812 			    if (indx == 0)
7813 			      htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7814 			    else if (is_static_defined (h))
7815 			      htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7816 			  }
7817 			outrel.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7818 					   + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7819 					   + off);
7820 			outrel.r_addend = 0;
7821 			if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7822 			  {
7823 			    outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPMOD32);
7824 			    if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7825 			      {
7826 				loc = rsec->contents;
7827 				loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
7828 					* sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
7829 				bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd,
7830 							   &outrel, loc);
7831 				outrel.r_offset += 4;
7832 				outrel.r_info
7833 				  = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7834 			      }
7835 			  }
7836 			else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7837 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7838 			else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL))
7839 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_TPREL32);
7840 			else if (indx != 0)
7841 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_GLOB_DAT);
7842 			else if (ifunc != NULL)
7843 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
7844 			else
7845 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
7846 			if (indx == 0 && tls_ty != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7847 			  {
7848 			    outrel.r_addend += relocation;
7849 			    if (tls_ty & (TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL))
7850 			      {
7851 				if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7852 				  outrel.r_addend = 0;
7853 				else
7854 				  outrel.r_addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma;
7855 			      }
7856 			  }
7857 			loc = rsec->contents;
7858 			loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
7859 				* sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
7860 			bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
7861 		      }
7862 
7863 		    /* Init the .got section contents if we're not
7864 		       emitting a reloc.  */
7865 		    else
7866 		      {
7867 			bfd_vma value = relocation;
7868 
7869 			if (tls_ty != 0)
7870 			  {
7871 			    if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7872 			      value = 0;
7873 			    else
7874 			      {
7875 				if (tls_ty & TLS_LD)
7876 				  value = 0;
7877 				else
7878 				  value -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7879 				if (tls_ty & TLS_TPREL)
7880 				  value += DTP_OFFSET - TP_OFFSET;
7881 			      }
7882 
7883 			    if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7884 			      {
7885 				bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7886 					    htab->elf.sgot->contents + off + 4);
7887 				value = 1;
7888 			      }
7889 			  }
7890 			bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7891 				    htab->elf.sgot->contents + off);
7892 		      }
7893 
7894 		    off += 4;
7895 		    if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7896 		      off += 4;
7897 		  }
7898 		while (tls_m != 0);
7899 
7900 		off = *offp;
7901 		*offp = off | 1;
7902 	      }
7903 
7904 	    if (off >= (bfd_vma) -2)
7905 	      abort ();
7906 
7907 	    if ((tls_type & TLS_TLS) != 0)
7908 	      {
7909 		if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7910 		  {
7911 		    if ((tls_mask & TLS_LD) != 0
7912 			&& !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7913 		      off += 8;
7914 		    if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7915 		      {
7916 			if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
7917 			  off += 8;
7918 			if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7919 			  {
7920 			    if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7921 			      off += 4;
7922 			  }
7923 		      }
7924 		  }
7925 	      }
7926 
7927 	    /* If here for a picfixup, we're done.  */
7928 	    if (r_type != ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
7929 	      goto copy_reloc;
7930 
7931 	    relocation = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7932 			  + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7933 			  + off
7934 			  - SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot));
7935 
7936 	    /* Addends on got relocations don't make much sense.
7937 	       x+off@got is actually x@got+off, and since the got is
7938 	       generated by a hash table traversal, the value in the
7939 	       got at entry m+n bears little relation to the entry m.  */
7940 	    if (addend != 0)
7941 	      info->callbacks->einfo
7942 		/* xgettext:c-format */
7943 		(_("%H: non-zero addend on %s reloc against `%s'\n"),
7944 		 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7945 		 howto->name,
7946 		 sym_name);
7947 	  }
7948 	  break;
7949 
7950 	  /* Relocations that need no special processing.  */
7951 	case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
7952 	  /* It makes no sense to point a local relocation
7953 	     at a symbol not in this object.  */
7954 	  if (unresolved_reloc)
7955 	    {
7956 	      (*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol) (info,
7957 						    h->root.root.string,
7958 						    input_bfd,
7959 						    input_section,
7960 						    rel->r_offset,
7961 						    true);
7962 	      goto copy_reloc;
7963 	    }
7964 	  if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && bfd_link_pic (info))
7965 	    {
7966 	      /* @local on an ifunc does not really make sense since
7967 		 the ifunc resolver can take you anywhere.  More
7968 		 seriously, calls to ifuncs must go through a plt call
7969 		 stub, and for pic the plt call stubs uses r30 to
7970 		 access the PLT.  The problem is that a call that is
7971 		 local won't have the +32k reloc addend trick marking
7972 		 -fPIC code, so the linker won't know whether r30 is
7973 		 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or pointing into a .got2 section.  */
7974 	      /* xgettext:c-format */
7975 	      info->callbacks->einfo (_("%X%H: @local call to ifunc %s\n"),
7976 				      input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7977 				      h->root.root.string);
7978 	    }
7979 	  break;
7980 
7981 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
7982 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
7983 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
7984 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
7985 	  if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
7986 	    addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7987 	  break;
7988 
7989 	  /* Relocations that may need to be propagated if this is a shared
7990 	     object.  */
7991 	case R_PPC_TPREL16:
7992 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
7993 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
7994 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
7995 	  if (h != NULL
7996 	      && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
7997 	      && h->dynindx == -1
7998 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7999 	    {
8000 	      /* Make this relocation against an undefined weak symbol
8001 		 resolve to zero.  This is really just a tweak, since
8002 		 code using weak externs ought to check that they are
8003 		 defined before using them.  */
8004 	      bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset;
8005 	      unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8006 	      insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (insn, 2);
8007 	      if (insn != 0)
8008 		bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
8009 	      break;
8010 	    }
8011 	  if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8012 	    addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8013 	  /* The TPREL16 relocs shouldn't really be used in shared
8014 	     libs or with non-local symbols as that will result in
8015 	     DT_TEXTREL being set, but support them anyway.  */
8016 	  goto dodyn;
8017 
8018 	case R_PPC_TPREL32:
8019 	  if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8020 	    addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8021 	  goto dodyn;
8022 
8023 	case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
8024 	  if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8025 	    addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
8026 	  goto dodyn;
8027 
8028 	case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
8029 	  relocation = 1;
8030 	  addend = 0;
8031 	  goto dodyn;
8032 
8033 	case R_PPC_REL16:
8034 	case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
8035 	case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
8036 	case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8037 	case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8038 	  break;
8039 
8040 	case R_PPC_REL32:
8041 	  if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
8042 	    break;
8043 	  /* fall through */
8044 
8045 	case R_PPC_ADDR32:
8046 	case R_PPC_ADDR16:
8047 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
8048 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
8049 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8050 	case R_PPC_UADDR32:
8051 	case R_PPC_UADDR16:
8052 	  goto dodyn;
8053 
8054 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
8055 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
8056 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
8057 	case R_PPC_REL24:
8058 	case R_PPC_REL14:
8059 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
8060 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
8061 	  /* If these relocations are not to a named symbol, they can be
8062 	     handled right here, no need to bother the dynamic linker.  */
8063 	  if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
8064 	      || h == htab->elf.hgot)
8065 	    break;
8066 	  /* fall through */
8067 
8068 	case R_PPC_ADDR24:
8069 	case R_PPC_ADDR14:
8070 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
8071 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
8072 	  if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
8073 	    break;
8074 	  /* fall through */
8075 
8076 	dodyn:
8077 	  if ((input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
8078 	      || is_vxworks_tls)
8079 	    break;
8080 
8081 	  if (bfd_link_pic (info)
8082 	      ? ((h == NULL
8083 		  || h->dyn_relocs != NULL)
8084 		 && ((h != NULL && pc_dynrelocs (h))
8085 		     || must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
8086 	      : (h != NULL
8087 		 && h->dyn_relocs != NULL))
8088 	    {
8089 	      int skip;
8090 	      bfd_byte *loc;
8091 	      asection *sreloc;
8092 	      long indx = 0;
8093 
8094 #ifdef DEBUG
8095 	      fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_relocate_section needs to "
8096 		       "create relocation for %s\n",
8097 		       (h && h->root.root.string
8098 			? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
8099 #endif
8100 
8101 	      /* When generating a shared object, these relocations
8102 		 are copied into the output file to be resolved at run
8103 		 time.  */
8104 	      skip = 0;
8105 	      outrel.r_offset = _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info,
8106 							 input_section,
8107 							 rel->r_offset);
8108 	      if (outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1
8109 		  || outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -2)
8110 		skip = (int) outrel.r_offset;
8111 	      outrel.r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
8112 				  + input_section->output_offset);
8113 
8114 	      /* Optimize unaligned reloc use.  */
8115 	      if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) != 0)
8116 		  || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) == 0))
8117 		r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR32 ^ R_PPC_UADDR32;
8118 	      if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) != 0)
8119 		  || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) == 0))
8120 		r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR16 ^ R_PPC_UADDR16;
8121 
8122 	      if (skip)
8123 		memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
8124 	      else if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
8125 		{
8126 		  indx = h->dynindx;
8127 		  BFD_ASSERT (indx != -1);
8128 		  unresolved_reloc = false;
8129 		  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8130 		  outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8131 		}
8132 	      else
8133 		{
8134 		  outrel.r_addend = relocation + rel->r_addend;
8135 
8136 		  if (r_type != R_PPC_ADDR32)
8137 		    {
8138 		      if (ifunc != NULL)
8139 			{
8140 			  /* If we get here when building a static
8141 			     executable, then the libc startup function
8142 			     responsible for applying indirect function
8143 			     relocations is going to complain about
8144 			     the reloc type.
8145 			     If we get here when building a dynamic
8146 			     executable, it will be because we have
8147 			     a text relocation.  The dynamic loader
8148 			     will set the text segment writable and
8149 			     non-executable to apply text relocations.
8150 			     So we'll segfault when trying to run the
8151 			     indirection function to resolve the reloc.  */
8152 			  info->callbacks->einfo
8153 			    /* xgettext:c-format */
8154 			    (_("%H: relocation %s for indirect "
8155 			       "function %s unsupported\n"),
8156 			     input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8157 			     howto->name,
8158 			     sym_name);
8159 			  ret = false;
8160 			}
8161 		      else if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF || bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
8162 			;
8163 		      else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
8164 			{
8165 			  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8166 			  ret = false;
8167 			}
8168 		      else
8169 			{
8170 			  asection *osec;
8171 
8172 			  /* We are turning this relocation into one
8173 			     against a section symbol.  It would be
8174 			     proper to subtract the symbol's value,
8175 			     osec->vma, from the emitted reloc addend,
8176 			     but ld.so expects buggy relocs.
8177 			     FIXME: Why not always use a zero index?  */
8178 			  osec = sec->output_section;
8179 			  if ((osec->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
8180 			    {
8181 			      osec = htab->elf.tls_sec;
8182 			      indx = 0;
8183 			    }
8184 			  else
8185 			    {
8186 			      indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8187 			      if (indx == 0)
8188 				{
8189 				  osec = htab->elf.text_index_section;
8190 				  indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8191 				}
8192 			      BFD_ASSERT (indx != 0);
8193 			    }
8194 
8195 			  /* ld.so doesn't expect buggy TLS relocs.
8196 			     Don't leave the symbol value in the
8197 			     addend for them.  */
8198 			  if (IS_PPC_TLS_RELOC (r_type))
8199 			    outrel.r_addend -= osec->vma;
8200 			}
8201 
8202 		      outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8203 		    }
8204 		  else if (ifunc != NULL)
8205 		    outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
8206 		  else
8207 		    outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
8208 		}
8209 
8210 	      sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
8211 	      if (ifunc)
8212 		{
8213 		  sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
8214 		  if (indx == 0)
8215 		    htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8216 		  else if (is_static_defined (h))
8217 		    htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8218 		}
8219 	      if (sreloc == NULL)
8220 		return false;
8221 
8222 	      loc = sreloc->contents;
8223 	      loc += sreloc->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8224 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
8225 
8226 	      if (skip == -1)
8227 		goto copy_reloc;
8228 
8229 	      /* This reloc will be computed at runtime.  Clear the memory
8230 		 so that it contains a predictable value for prelink.  */
8231 	      if (!skip)
8232 		{
8233 		  relocation = howto->pc_relative ? outrel.r_offset : 0;
8234 		  addend = 0;
8235 		  break;
8236 		}
8237 	    }
8238 	  break;
8239 
8240 	case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
8241 	case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
8242 	  if (h != NULL)
8243 	    {
8244 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
8245 	      bfd_vma got2_addend = 0;
8246 
8247 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
8248 		{
8249 		  if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8250 		    got2_addend = addend;
8251 		  addend = 0;
8252 		}
8253 	      ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2, got2_addend);
8254 	      if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8255 		relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8256 			      + htab->glink->output_offset
8257 			      + ent->glink_offset);
8258 	      else
8259 		relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8260 			      + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8261 			      + ent->plt.offset);
8262 	    }
8263 	  /* Fall through.  */
8264 
8265 	case R_PPC_RELAX:
8266 	  if (bfd_link_pic (info)
8267 	      ? offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - 12,
8268 				 ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry) * 4)
8269 	      : offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset,
8270 				 ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry) * 4))
8271 	    {
8272 	      const int *stub;
8273 	      size_t size;
8274 	      size_t insn_offset = rel->r_offset;
8275 	      unsigned int insn;
8276 
8277 	      if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8278 		{
8279 		  relocation -= (input_section->output_section->vma
8280 				 + input_section->output_offset
8281 				 + rel->r_offset - 4);
8282 		  stub = shared_stub_entry;
8283 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[0], contents + insn_offset - 12);
8284 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[1], contents + insn_offset - 8);
8285 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[2], contents + insn_offset - 4);
8286 		  stub += 3;
8287 		  size = ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry) - 3;
8288 		}
8289 	      else
8290 		{
8291 		  stub = stub_entry;
8292 		  size = ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
8293 		}
8294 
8295 	      relocation += addend;
8296 	      if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
8297 		relocation = 0;
8298 
8299 	      /* First insn is HA, second is LO.  */
8300 	      insn = *stub++;
8301 	      insn |= ((relocation + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
8302 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8303 	      insn_offset += 4;
8304 
8305 	      insn = *stub++;
8306 	      insn |= relocation & 0xffff;
8307 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8308 	      insn_offset += 4;
8309 	      size -= 2;
8310 
8311 	      while (size != 0)
8312 		{
8313 		  insn = *stub++;
8314 		  --size;
8315 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8316 		  insn_offset += 4;
8317 		}
8318 
8319 	      /* Rewrite the reloc and convert one of the trailing nop
8320 		 relocs to describe this relocation.  */
8321 	      BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_NONE);
8322 	      /* The relocs are at the bottom 2 bytes */
8323 	      wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset + d_offset;
8324 	      wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
8325 	      wrel->r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8326 	      memmove (wrel + 1, wrel, (relend - wrel - 1) * sizeof (*wrel));
8327 	      wrel++, rel++;
8328 	      wrel->r_offset += 4;
8329 	      wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
8330 	    }
8331 	  else
8332 	    goto de_fault;
8333 	  continue;
8334 
8335 	  /* Indirect .sdata relocation.  */
8336 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
8337 	  BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[0].section != NULL);
8338 	  if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[0].sym))
8339 	    {
8340 	      unresolved_reloc = true;
8341 	      break;
8342 	    }
8343 	  relocation
8344 	    = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[0],
8345 						 h, relocation, rel);
8346 	  addend = 0;
8347 	  break;
8348 
8349 	  /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation.  */
8350 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
8351 	  BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[1].section != NULL);
8352 	  if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[1].sym))
8353 	    {
8354 	      unresolved_reloc = true;
8355 	      break;
8356 	    }
8357 	  relocation
8358 	    = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[1],
8359 						 h, relocation, rel);
8360 	  addend = 0;
8361 	  break;
8362 
8363 	  /* Handle the TOC16 reloc.  We want to use the offset within the .got
8364 	     section, not the actual VMA.  This is appropriate when generating
8365 	     an embedded ELF object, for which the .got section acts like the
8366 	     AIX .toc section.  */
8367 	case R_PPC_TOC16:			/* phony GOT16 relocations */
8368 	  if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8369 	    {
8370 	      unresolved_reloc = true;
8371 	      break;
8372 	    }
8373 	  BFD_ASSERT (strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".got") == 0
8374 		      || strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".cgot") == 0);
8375 
8376 	  addend -= sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset + 0x8000;
8377 	  break;
8378 
8379 	case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
8380 	  if (h != NULL && ifunc == NULL)
8381 	    {
8382 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
8383 
8384 	      ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2,
8385 				  bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8386 	      if (ent == NULL
8387 		  || htab->elf.splt == NULL)
8388 		{
8389 		  /* We didn't make a PLT entry for this symbol.  This
8390 		     happens when statically linking PIC code, or when
8391 		     using -Bsymbolic.  */
8392 		}
8393 	      else
8394 		{
8395 		  /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the
8396 		     procedure linkage table.  */
8397 		  unresolved_reloc = false;
8398 		  if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8399 		    relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8400 				  + htab->glink->output_offset
8401 				  + ent->glink_offset);
8402 		  else
8403 		    relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8404 				  + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8405 				  + ent->plt.offset);
8406 		}
8407 	    }
8408 
8409 	  /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special.  If non-zero, the
8410 	     addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2.
8411 	     Don't apply it to the relocation field.  */
8412 	  addend = 0;
8413 	  break;
8414 
8415 	case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8416 	case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8417 	case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8418 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
8419 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8420 	  plt_list = NULL;
8421 	  if (h != NULL)
8422 	    plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
8423 	  else if (ifunc != NULL)
8424 	    plt_list = ifunc;
8425 	  else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
8426 	    {
8427 	      struct plt_entry **local_plt;
8428 	      local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
8429 						 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
8430 	      plt_list = local_plt + r_symndx;
8431 	    }
8432 	  unresolved_reloc = true;
8433 	  if (plt_list != NULL)
8434 	    {
8435 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
8436 
8437 	      ent = find_plt_ent (plt_list, got2,
8438 				  bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8439 	      if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
8440 		{
8441 		  asection *plt;
8442 
8443 		  unresolved_reloc = false;
8444 		  plt = htab->elf.splt;
8445 		  if (use_local_plt (info, h))
8446 		    {
8447 		      if (ifunc != NULL)
8448 			plt = htab->elf.iplt;
8449 		      else
8450 			plt = htab->pltlocal;
8451 		    }
8452 		  relocation = (plt->output_section->vma
8453 				+ plt->output_offset
8454 				+ ent->plt.offset);
8455 		  if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8456 		    {
8457 		      bfd_vma got = 0;
8458 
8459 		      if (ent->addend >= 32768)
8460 			got = (ent->addend
8461 			       + ent->sec->output_section->vma
8462 			       + ent->sec->output_offset);
8463 		      else
8464 			got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
8465 		      relocation -= got;
8466 		    }
8467 		}
8468 	    }
8469 	  addend = 0;
8470 	  break;
8471 
8472 	  /* Relocate against _SDA_BASE_.  */
8473 	case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8474 	  {
8475 	    const char *name;
8476 	    struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8477 
8478 	    if (sec == NULL
8479 		|| sec->output_section == NULL
8480 		|| !is_static_defined (sda))
8481 	      {
8482 		unresolved_reloc = true;
8483 		break;
8484 	      }
8485 	    addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8486 
8487 	    name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8488 	    if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8489 		  || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0))
8490 	      {
8491 		_bfd_error_handler
8492 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
8493 		  (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8494 		     "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8495 		   input_bfd,
8496 		   sym_name,
8497 		   howto->name,
8498 		   name);
8499 	      }
8500 	  }
8501 	  break;
8502 
8503 	  /* Relocate against _SDA2_BASE_.  */
8504 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
8505 	  {
8506 	    const char *name;
8507 	    struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8508 
8509 	    if (sec == NULL
8510 		|| sec->output_section == NULL
8511 		|| !is_static_defined (sda))
8512 	      {
8513 		unresolved_reloc = true;
8514 		break;
8515 	      }
8516 	    addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8517 
8518 	    name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8519 	    if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8520 		  || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0))
8521 	      {
8522 		_bfd_error_handler
8523 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
8524 		  (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8525 		     "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8526 		   input_bfd,
8527 		   sym_name,
8528 		   howto->name,
8529 		   name);
8530 	      }
8531 	  }
8532 	  break;
8533 
8534 	case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
8535 	  relocation = relocation + addend;
8536 	  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8537 				   contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8538 				   split16a_type,
8539 				   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8540 	  goto report_reloc;
8541 
8542 	case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
8543 	  relocation = relocation + addend;
8544 	  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8545 				   contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8546 				   split16d_type,
8547 				   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8548 	  goto report_reloc;
8549 
8550 	case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
8551 	  relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8552 	  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8553 				   contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8554 				   split16a_type,
8555 				   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8556 	  goto report_reloc;
8557 
8558 	case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
8559 	  relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8560 	  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8561 				   contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8562 				   split16d_type,
8563 				   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8564 	  goto report_reloc;
8565 
8566 	case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
8567 	  relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8568 	  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8569 				   contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8570 				   split16a_type,
8571 				   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8572 	  goto report_reloc;
8573 
8574 	case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
8575 	  relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8576 	  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8577 				   contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8578 				   split16d_type,
8579 				   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8580 	  goto report_reloc;
8581 
8582 	  /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_, _SDA2_BASE_, or 0.  */
8583 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
8584 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
8585 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
8586 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
8587 	  if (!offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
8588 	    {
8589 	      r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
8590 	      goto report_reloc;
8591 	    }
8592 	  else
8593 	    {
8594 	      const char *name;
8595 	      int reg;
8596 	      unsigned int insn;
8597 	      struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8598 
8599 	      if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8600 		{
8601 		  unresolved_reloc = true;
8602 		  break;
8603 		}
8604 
8605 	      name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8606 	      if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8607 		  || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8608 		{
8609 		  reg = 13;
8610 		  sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8611 		}
8612 	      else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8613 		       || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8614 		{
8615 		  reg = 2;
8616 		  sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8617 		}
8618 	      else if (strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sdata0") == 0
8619 		       || strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0") == 0)
8620 		{
8621 		  reg = 0;
8622 		}
8623 	      else
8624 		{
8625 		  _bfd_error_handler
8626 		    /* xgettext:c-format */
8627 		    (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8628 		       "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8629 		     input_bfd,
8630 		     sym_name,
8631 		     howto->name,
8632 		     name);
8633 
8634 		  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8635 		  ret = false;
8636 		  goto copy_reloc;
8637 		}
8638 
8639 	      if (sda != NULL)
8640 		{
8641 		  if (!is_static_defined (sda))
8642 		    {
8643 		      unresolved_reloc = true;
8644 		      break;
8645 		    }
8646 		  addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8647 		}
8648 
8649 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA)
8650 		break;
8651 
8652 	      /* The PowerPC Embedded Application Binary Interface
8653 		 version 1.0 insanely chose to specify R_PPC_EMB_SDA21
8654 		 operating on a 24-bit field at r_offset.  GNU as and
8655 		 GNU ld have always assumed R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 operates on
8656 		 a 32-bit bit insn at r_offset.  Cope with object file
8657 		 producers that possibly comply with the EABI in
8658 		 generating an odd r_offset for big-endian objects.  */
8659 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_SDA21)
8660 		rel->r_offset &= ~1;
8661 
8662 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
8663 	      if (reg == 0
8664 		  && (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8665 		      || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO))
8666 		{
8667 		  relocation = relocation + addend;
8668 		  addend = 0;
8669 
8670 		  /* Force e_li insn, keeping RT from original insn.  */
8671 		  insn &= 0x1f << 21;
8672 		  insn |= 28u << 26;
8673 
8674 		  /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31.  */
8675 		  /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20.  */
8676 		  insn |= (relocation & 0xf0000) >> 5;
8677 		  /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15.  */
8678 		  insn |= (relocation & 0xf800) << 5;
8679 		  /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31.  */
8680 		  insn |= relocation & 0x7ff;
8681 
8682 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8683 
8684 		  r = bfd_reloc_ok;
8685 		  if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8686 		      && ((relocation + 0x80000) & 0xffffffff) > 0x100000)
8687 		    r = bfd_reloc_overflow;
8688 		  goto report_reloc;
8689 		}
8690 	      /* Fill in register field.  */
8691 	      insn = (insn & ~RA_REGISTER_MASK) | (reg << RA_REGISTER_SHIFT);
8692 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8693 	    }
8694 	  break;
8695 
8696 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
8697 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
8698 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
8699 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
8700 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
8701 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
8702 	  if (!offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
8703 	    r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
8704 	  else
8705 	    {
8706 	      bfd_vma value;
8707 	      const char *name;
8708 	      struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8709 
8710 	      if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8711 		{
8712 		  unresolved_reloc = true;
8713 		  break;
8714 		}
8715 
8716 	      name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8717 	      if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8718 		  || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8719 		sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8720 	      else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8721 		       || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8722 		sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8723 	      else
8724 		{
8725 		  _bfd_error_handler
8726 		    /* xgettext:c-format */
8727 		    (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8728 		       "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8729 		     input_bfd,
8730 		     sym_name,
8731 		     howto->name,
8732 		     name);
8733 
8734 		  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8735 		  ret = false;
8736 		  goto copy_reloc;
8737 		}
8738 
8739 	      if (sda == NULL || !is_static_defined (sda))
8740 		{
8741 		  unresolved_reloc = true;
8742 		  break;
8743 		}
8744 	      value = relocation + addend - SYM_VAL (sda);
8745 
8746 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A)
8747 		r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
8748 					 rel->r_offset,
8749 					 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8750 					 split16a_type,
8751 					 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8752 	      else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D)
8753 		r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
8754 					 rel->r_offset,
8755 					 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8756 					 split16d_type,
8757 					 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8758 	      else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A)
8759 		{
8760 		  value = value >> 16;
8761 		  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
8762 					   rel->r_offset,
8763 					   contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8764 					   split16a_type,
8765 					   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8766 		}
8767 	      else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D)
8768 		{
8769 		  value = value >> 16;
8770 		  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
8771 					   rel->r_offset,
8772 					   contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8773 					   split16d_type,
8774 					   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8775 		}
8776 	      else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A)
8777 		{
8778 		  value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8779 		  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
8780 					   rel->r_offset,
8781 					   contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8782 					   split16a_type,
8783 					   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8784 		}
8785 	      else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D)
8786 		{
8787 		  value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8788 		  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
8789 					   rel->r_offset,
8790 					   contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8791 					   split16d_type,
8792 					   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8793 		}
8794 	      else
8795 		abort ();
8796 	    }
8797 	  goto report_reloc;
8798 
8799 	case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
8800 	  if (!offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
8801 	    r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
8802 	  else
8803 	    {
8804 	      ppc_elf_vle_split20 (output_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset,
8805 				   relocation);
8806 	      r = bfd_reloc_ok;
8807 	    }
8808 	  goto report_reloc;
8809 
8810 	  /* Relocate against the beginning of the section.  */
8811 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8812 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8813 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
8814 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8815 	  if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8816 	    {
8817 	      unresolved_reloc = true;
8818 	      break;
8819 	    }
8820 	  addend -= sec->output_section->vma;
8821 	  break;
8822 
8823 	  /* Negative relocations.  */
8824 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
8825 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
8826 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
8827 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
8828 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8829 	  addend -= 2 * relocation;
8830 	  break;
8831 
8832 	case R_PPC_COPY:
8833 	case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
8834 	case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
8835 	case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
8836 	case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
8837 	case R_PPC_PLT32:
8838 	case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
8839 	case R_PPC_ADDR30:
8840 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
8841 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
8842 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
8843 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8844 	case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
8845 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
8846 	  _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
8847 			      input_bfd, howto->name);
8848 
8849 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8850 	  ret = false;
8851 	  goto copy_reloc;
8852 	}
8853 
8854       switch (r_type)
8855 	{
8856 	default:
8857 	  break;
8858 
8859 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8860 	  if (htab->do_tls_opt
8861 	      && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000
8862 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
8863 
8864 	    {
8865 	      bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
8866 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
8867 	    }
8868 	  break;
8869 
8870 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8871 	  if (htab->do_tls_opt
8872 	      && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000
8873 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
8874 	    {
8875 	      bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
8876 	      unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8877 	      insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
8878 	      insn |= 2 << 16;
8879 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
8880 	    }
8881 	  break;
8882 	}
8883 
8884       switch (r_type)
8885 	{
8886 	default:
8887 	  break;
8888 
8889 	case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8890 	  if (unresolved_reloc)
8891 	    {
8892 	      if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
8893 		{
8894 		  bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset;
8895 		  unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8896 		  insn &= 1;
8897 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | insn, p);
8898 		  unresolved_reloc = save_unresolved_reloc;
8899 		  r_type = R_PPC_REL24;
8900 		  howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8901 		}
8902 	    }
8903 	  else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8904 	    info->callbacks->einfo
8905 	      (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8906 	       input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8907 	       howto->name);
8908 	  break;
8909 
8910 	case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8911 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8912 	case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8913 	  if (unresolved_reloc)
8914 	    {
8915 	      if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
8916 		{
8917 		  bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
8918 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
8919 		  unresolved_reloc = false;
8920 		  r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
8921 		  howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8922 		}
8923 	    }
8924 	  else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8925 	    info->callbacks->einfo
8926 	      (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8927 	       input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8928 	       howto->name);
8929 	  break;
8930 	}
8931 
8932       /* Do any further special processing.  */
8933       switch (r_type)
8934 	{
8935 	default:
8936 	  break;
8937 
8938 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8939 	case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8940 	case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8941 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8942 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8943 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
8944 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8945 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8946 	  /* It's just possible that this symbol is a weak symbol
8947 	     that's not actually defined anywhere.  In that case,
8948 	     'sec' would be NULL, and we should leave the symbol
8949 	     alone (it will be set to zero elsewhere in the link).  */
8950 	  if (sec == NULL)
8951 	    break;
8952 	  /* Fall through.  */
8953 
8954 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8955 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
8956 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
8957 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
8958 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
8959 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
8960 	  /* Add 0x10000 if sign bit in 0:15 is set.
8961 	     Bits 0:15 are not used.  */
8962 	  addend += 0x8000;
8963 	  break;
8964 
8965 	case R_PPC_ADDR16:
8966 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
8967 	case R_PPC_GOT16:
8968 	case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
8969 	case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8970 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8971 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8972 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
8973 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
8974 	case R_PPC_TPREL16:
8975 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8976 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
8977 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
8978 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
8979 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
8980 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
8981 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
8982 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
8983 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
8984 	  if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
8985 	    {
8986 	      /* The 32-bit ABI lacks proper relocations to deal with
8987 		 certain 64-bit instructions.  Prevent damage to bits
8988 		 that make up part of the insn opcode.  */
8989 	      unsigned int insn, mask, lobit;
8990 
8991 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
8992 				 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
8993 	      mask = 0;
8994 	      if (is_insn_ds_form (insn))
8995 		mask = 3;
8996 	      else if (is_insn_dq_form (insn))
8997 		mask = 15;
8998 	      else
8999 		break;
9000 	      relocation += addend;
9001 	      addend = insn & mask;
9002 	      lobit = mask & relocation;
9003 	      if (lobit != 0)
9004 		{
9005 		  relocation ^= lobit;
9006 		  info->callbacks->einfo
9007 		    /* xgettext:c-format */
9008 		    (_("%H: error: %s against `%s' not a multiple of %u\n"),
9009 		     input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
9010 		     howto->name, sym_name, mask + 1);
9011 		  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
9012 		  ret = false;
9013 		}
9014 	    }
9015 	  break;
9016 	}
9017 
9018 #ifdef DEBUG
9019       fprintf (stderr, "\ttype = %s (%d), name = %s, symbol index = %ld, "
9020 	       "offset = %ld, addend = %ld\n",
9021 	       howto->name,
9022 	       (int) r_type,
9023 	       sym_name,
9024 	       r_symndx,
9025 	       (long) rel->r_offset,
9026 	       (long) addend);
9027 #endif
9028 
9029       if (unresolved_reloc
9030 	  && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
9031 	       && h->def_dynamic)
9032 	  && _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section,
9033 				      rel->r_offset) != (bfd_vma) -1)
9034 	{
9035 	  info->callbacks->einfo
9036 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
9037 	    (_("%H: unresolvable %s relocation against symbol `%s'\n"),
9038 	     input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
9039 	     howto->name,
9040 	     sym_name);
9041 	  ret = false;
9042 	}
9043 
9044       /* 16-bit fields in insns mostly have signed values, but a
9045 	 few insns have 16-bit unsigned values.  Really, we should
9046 	 have different reloc types.  */
9047       if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain_overflow_dont
9048 	  && howto->dst_mask == 0xffff
9049 	  && (input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
9050 	  && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
9051 	{
9052 	  enum complain_overflow complain = complain_overflow_signed;
9053 
9054 	  if ((elf_section_flags (input_section) & SHF_PPC_VLE) == 0)
9055 	    {
9056 	      unsigned int insn;
9057 
9058 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
9059 	      if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 10u << 26 /* cmpli */)
9060 		complain = complain_overflow_bitfield;
9061 	      else if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi */
9062 		       || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori */
9063 		       || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori */)
9064 		complain = complain_overflow_unsigned;
9065 	    }
9066 	  if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain)
9067 	    {
9068 	      alt_howto = *howto;
9069 	      alt_howto.complain_on_overflow = complain;
9070 	      howto = &alt_howto;
9071 	    }
9072 	}
9073 
9074       if (r_type == R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
9075 	{
9076 	  /* Split field reloc isn't handled by _bfd_final_link_relocate.  */
9077 	  if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
9078 	    r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
9079 	  else
9080 	    {
9081 	      unsigned int insn;
9082 
9083 	      relocation += addend;
9084 	      relocation -= (rel->r_offset
9085 			     + input_section->output_offset
9086 			     + input_section->output_section->vma);
9087 	      relocation >>= 16;
9088 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
9089 	      insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
9090 	      insn |= (relocation & 0xffc1) | ((relocation & 0x3e) << 15);
9091 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
9092 	      r = bfd_reloc_ok;
9093 	    }
9094 	}
9095       else
9096 	r = _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section, contents,
9097 				      rel->r_offset, relocation, addend);
9098 
9099     report_reloc:
9100       if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
9101 	{
9102 	  if (r == bfd_reloc_overflow)
9103 	    {
9104 	      /* On code like "if (foo) foo();" don't report overflow
9105 		 on a branch to zero when foo is undefined.  */
9106 	      if (!warned
9107 		  && !(h != NULL
9108 		       && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
9109 			   || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
9110 		       && is_branch_reloc (r_type)))
9111 		info->callbacks->reloc_overflow
9112 		  (info, (h ? &h->root : NULL), sym_name, howto->name,
9113 		   rel->r_addend, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
9114 	    }
9115 	  else
9116 	    {
9117 	      info->callbacks->einfo
9118 		/* xgettext:c-format */
9119 		(_("%H: %s reloc against `%s': error %d\n"),
9120 		 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
9121 		 howto->name, sym_name, (int) r);
9122 	      ret = false;
9123 	    }
9124 	}
9125     copy_reloc:
9126       if (wrel != rel)
9127 	*wrel = *rel;
9128     }
9129 
9130   if (wrel != rel)
9131     {
9132       Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
9133       size_t deleted = rel - wrel;
9134 
9135       rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section->output_section);
9136       rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9137       if (rel_hdr->sh_size == 0)
9138 	{
9139 	  /* It is too late to remove an empty reloc section.  Leave
9140 	     one NONE reloc.
9141 	     ??? What is wrong with an empty section???  */
9142 	  rel_hdr->sh_size = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
9143 	  deleted -= 1;
9144 	  wrel++;
9145 	}
9146       relend = wrel;
9147       rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section);
9148       rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9149       input_section->reloc_count -= deleted;
9150     }
9151 
9152 #ifdef DEBUG
9153   fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9154 #endif
9155 
9156   if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9157       && input_section->size != input_section->rawsize
9158       && (strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
9159 	  || strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0))
9160     {
9161       /* Branch around the trampolines.  */
9162       unsigned int insn = B + input_section->size - input_section->rawsize;
9163       bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + input_section->rawsize);
9164     }
9165 
9166   if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
9167       && input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9168       && (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
9169 	  || (input_section->output_section->alignment_power
9170 	      >= htab->params->pagesize_p2)))
9171     {
9172       bfd_vma start_addr, end_addr, addr;
9173       bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
9174 
9175       if (relax_info->workaround_size != 0)
9176 	{
9177 	  bfd_byte *p;
9178 	  unsigned int n;
9179 	  bfd_byte fill[4];
9180 
9181 	  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, BA, fill);
9182 	  p = contents + input_section->size - relax_info->workaround_size;
9183 	  n = relax_info->workaround_size >> 2;
9184 	  while (n--)
9185 	    {
9186 	      memcpy (p, fill, 4);
9187 	      p += 4;
9188 	    }
9189 	}
9190 
9191       /* The idea is: Replace the last instruction on a page with a
9192 	 branch to a patch area.  Put the insn there followed by a
9193 	 branch back to the next page.  Complicated a little by
9194 	 needing to handle moved conditional branches, and by not
9195 	 wanting to touch data-in-text.  */
9196 
9197       start_addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
9198 		    + input_section->output_offset);
9199       end_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9200 		  - relax_info->workaround_size);
9201       for (addr = ((start_addr & -pagesize) + pagesize - 4);
9202 	   addr < end_addr;
9203 	   addr += pagesize)
9204 	{
9205 	  bfd_vma offset = addr - start_addr;
9206 	  Elf_Internal_Rela *lo, *hi;
9207 	  bool is_data;
9208 	  bfd_vma patch_off, patch_addr;
9209 	  unsigned int insn;
9210 
9211 	  /* Do we have a data reloc at this offset?  If so, leave
9212 	     the word alone.  */
9213 	  is_data = false;
9214 	  lo = relocs;
9215 	  hi = relend;
9216 	  rel = NULL;
9217 	  while (lo < hi)
9218 	    {
9219 	      rel = lo + (hi - lo) / 2;
9220 	      if (rel->r_offset < offset)
9221 		lo = rel + 1;
9222 	      else if (rel->r_offset > offset + 3)
9223 		hi = rel;
9224 	      else
9225 		{
9226 		  switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
9227 		    {
9228 		    case R_PPC_ADDR32:
9229 		    case R_PPC_UADDR32:
9230 		    case R_PPC_REL32:
9231 		    case R_PPC_ADDR30:
9232 		      is_data = true;
9233 		      break;
9234 		    default:
9235 		      break;
9236 		    }
9237 		  break;
9238 		}
9239 	    }
9240 	  if (is_data)
9241 	    continue;
9242 
9243 	  /* Some instructions can be left alone too.  Unconditional
9244 	     branches, except for bcctr with BO=0x14 (bctr, bctrl),
9245 	     avoid the icache failure.
9246 
9247 	     The problem occurs due to prefetch across a page boundary
9248 	     where stale instructions can be fetched from the next
9249 	     page, and the mechanism for flushing these bad
9250 	     instructions fails under certain circumstances.  The
9251 	     unconditional branches:
9252 	     1) Branch: b, bl, ba, bla,
9253 	     2) Branch Conditional: bc, bca, bcl, bcla,
9254 	     3) Branch Conditional to Link Register: bclr, bclrl,
9255 	     where (2) and (3) have BO=0x14 making them unconditional,
9256 	     prevent the bad prefetch because the prefetch itself is
9257 	     affected by these instructions.  This happens even if the
9258 	     instruction is not executed.
9259 
9260 	     A bctr example:
9261 	     .
9262 	     .	lis 9,new_page@ha
9263 	     .	addi 9,9,new_page@l
9264 	     .	mtctr 9
9265 	     .	bctr
9266 	     .	nop
9267 	     .	nop
9268 	     . new_page:
9269 	     .
9270 	     The bctr is not predicted taken due to ctr not being
9271 	     ready, so prefetch continues on past the bctr into the
9272 	     new page which might have stale instructions.  If they
9273 	     fail to be flushed, then they will be executed after the
9274 	     bctr executes.  Either of the following modifications
9275 	     prevent the bad prefetch from happening in the first
9276 	     place:
9277 	     .
9278 	     .	lis 9,new_page@ha	 lis 9,new_page@ha
9279 	     .	addi 9,9,new_page@l	 addi 9,9,new_page@l
9280 	     .	mtctr 9			 mtctr 9
9281 	     .	bctr			 bctr
9282 	     .	nop			 b somewhere_else
9283 	     .	b somewhere_else	 nop
9284 	     . new_page:		new_page:
9285 	     .  */
9286 	  insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
9287 	  if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (18u << 26)	    /* b,bl,ba,bla */
9288 	      || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (16u << 26)	    /* bc,bcl,bca,bcla*/
9289 		  && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)) /*	 with BO=0x14 */
9290 	      || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (19u << 26)
9291 		  && (insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == (16u << 1)    /* bclr,bclrl */
9292 		  && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)))/*	 with BO=0x14 */
9293 	    continue;
9294 
9295 	  patch_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9296 			- relax_info->workaround_size);
9297 	  patch_addr = (patch_addr + 15) & -16;
9298 	  patch_off = patch_addr - start_addr;
9299 	  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B + patch_off - offset, contents + offset);
9300 
9301 	  if (rel != NULL
9302 	      && rel->r_offset >= offset
9303 	      && rel->r_offset < offset + 4)
9304 	    {
9305 	      asection *sreloc;
9306 
9307 	      /* If the insn we are patching had a reloc, adjust the
9308 		 reloc r_offset so that the reloc applies to the moved
9309 		 location.  This matters for -r and --emit-relocs.  */
9310 	      if (rel + 1 != relend)
9311 		{
9312 		  Elf_Internal_Rela tmp = *rel;
9313 
9314 		  /* Keep the relocs sorted by r_offset.  */
9315 		  memmove (rel, rel + 1, (relend - (rel + 1)) * sizeof (*rel));
9316 		  relend[-1] = tmp;
9317 		}
9318 	      relend[-1].r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9319 
9320 	      /* Adjust REL16 addends too.  */
9321 	      switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info))
9322 		{
9323 		case R_PPC_REL16:
9324 		case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
9325 		case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
9326 		case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
9327 		  relend[-1].r_addend += patch_off - offset;
9328 		  break;
9329 		default:
9330 		  break;
9331 		}
9332 
9333 	      /* If we are building a PIE or shared library with
9334 		 non-PIC objects, perhaps we had a dynamic reloc too?
9335 		 If so, the dynamic reloc must move with the insn.  */
9336 	      sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
9337 	      if (sreloc != NULL)
9338 		{
9339 		  Elf32_External_Rela *slo, *shi, *srelend;
9340 		  bfd_vma soffset;
9341 
9342 		  slo = (Elf32_External_Rela *) sreloc->contents;
9343 		  shi = srelend = slo + sreloc->reloc_count;
9344 		  soffset = (offset + input_section->output_section->vma
9345 			     + input_section->output_offset);
9346 		  while (slo < shi)
9347 		    {
9348 		      Elf32_External_Rela *srel = slo + (shi - slo) / 2;
9349 		      bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, (bfd_byte *) srel,
9350 						&outrel);
9351 		      if (outrel.r_offset < soffset)
9352 			slo = srel + 1;
9353 		      else if (outrel.r_offset > soffset + 3)
9354 			shi = srel;
9355 		      else
9356 			{
9357 			  if (srel + 1 != srelend)
9358 			    {
9359 			      memmove (srel, srel + 1,
9360 				       (srelend - (srel + 1)) * sizeof (*srel));
9361 			      srel = srelend - 1;
9362 			    }
9363 			  outrel.r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9364 			  bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel,
9365 						     (bfd_byte *) srel);
9366 			  break;
9367 			}
9368 		    }
9369 		}
9370 	    }
9371 	  else
9372 	    rel = NULL;
9373 
9374 	  if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc */
9375 	      && (insn & 2) == 0 /* relative */)
9376 	    {
9377 	      bfd_vma delta = ((insn & 0xfffc) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
9378 
9379 	      delta += offset - patch_off;
9380 	      if (bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9381 		delta = 0;
9382 	      if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9383 		{
9384 		  enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
9385 
9386 		  r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info);
9387 		  if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN)
9388 		    insn |= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9389 		  else if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9390 		    insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9391 		  else
9392 		    BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_PPC_REL14);
9393 
9394 		  if ((r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
9395 		       || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9396 		      && delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000
9397 		      && (bfd_signed_vma) delta < 0)
9398 		    insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9399 		}
9400 	      if (delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
9401 		{
9402 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9403 			      (insn & ~0xfffc) | (delta & 0xfffc),
9404 			      contents + patch_off);
9405 		  patch_off += 4;
9406 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9407 			      B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9408 			      contents + patch_off);
9409 		  patch_off += 4;
9410 		}
9411 	      else
9412 		{
9413 		  if (rel != NULL)
9414 		    {
9415 		      unsigned int r_sym = ELF32_R_SYM (relend[-1].r_info);
9416 
9417 		      relend[-1].r_offset += 8;
9418 		      relend[-1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_sym, R_PPC_REL24);
9419 		    }
9420 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9421 			      (insn & ~0xfffc) | 8,
9422 			      contents + patch_off);
9423 		  patch_off += 4;
9424 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9425 			      B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9426 			      contents + patch_off);
9427 		  patch_off += 4;
9428 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9429 			      B | ((delta - 8) & 0x3fffffc),
9430 			      contents + patch_off);
9431 		  patch_off += 4;
9432 		}
9433 	    }
9434 	  else
9435 	    {
9436 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + patch_off);
9437 	      patch_off += 4;
9438 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9439 			  B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9440 			  contents + patch_off);
9441 	      patch_off += 4;
9442 	    }
9443 	  BFD_ASSERT (patch_off <= input_section->size);
9444 	  relax_info->workaround_size = input_section->size - patch_off;
9445 	}
9446     }
9447 
9448   return ret;
9449 }
9450 
9451 /* Write out the PLT relocs and entries for H.  */
9452 
9453 static bool
write_global_sym_plt(struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,void * inf)9454 write_global_sym_plt (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
9455 {
9456   struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
9457   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9458   struct plt_entry *ent;
9459   bool doneone;
9460 
9461   doneone = false;
9462   for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9463     if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9464       {
9465 	bool dyn = !use_local_plt (info, h);
9466 
9467 	if (!doneone)
9468 	  {
9469 	    Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9470 	    bfd_byte *loc;
9471 	    bfd_vma reloc_index;
9472 	    asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9473 	    asection *relplt = htab->elf.srelplt;
9474 
9475 	    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
9476 	      reloc_index = ent->plt.offset / 4;
9477 	    else
9478 	      {
9479 		reloc_index = ((ent->plt.offset - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
9480 			       / htab->plt_slot_size);
9481 		if (reloc_index > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES
9482 		    && htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
9483 		  reloc_index -= (reloc_index - PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES) / 2;
9484 	      }
9485 
9486 	    /* This symbol has an entry in the procedure linkage table.
9487 	       Set it up.  */
9488 	    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS && dyn)
9489 	      {
9490 		bfd_vma got_offset;
9491 		const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
9492 
9493 		/* The first three entries in .got.plt are reserved.  */
9494 		got_offset = (reloc_index + 3) * 4;
9495 
9496 		/* Use the right PLT. */
9497 		plt_entry = bfd_link_pic (info) ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
9498 			    : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry;
9499 
9500 		/* Fill in the .plt on VxWorks.  */
9501 		if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9502 		  {
9503 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9504 				plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_offset),
9505 				plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9506 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9507 				plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_offset),
9508 				plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9509 		  }
9510 		else
9511 		  {
9512 		    bfd_vma got_loc = got_offset + SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9513 
9514 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9515 				plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_loc),
9516 				plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9517 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9518 				plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_loc),
9519 				plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9520 		  }
9521 
9522 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[2],
9523 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 8);
9524 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[3],
9525 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 12);
9526 
9527 		/* This instruction is an immediate load.  The value loaded is
9528 		   the byte offset of the R_PPC_JMP_SLOT relocation from the
9529 		   start of the .rela.plt section.  The value is stored in the
9530 		   low-order 16 bits of the load instruction.  */
9531 		/* NOTE: It appears that this is now an index rather than a
9532 		   prescaled offset.  */
9533 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9534 			    plt_entry[4] | reloc_index,
9535 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 16);
9536 		/* This instruction is a PC-relative branch whose target is
9537 		   the start of the PLT section.  The address of this branch
9538 		   instruction is 20 bytes beyond the start of this PLT entry.
9539 		   The address is encoded in bits 6-29, inclusive.  The value
9540 		   stored is right-shifted by two bits, permitting a 26-bit
9541 		   offset.  */
9542 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9543 			    (plt_entry[5]
9544 			     | (-(ent->plt.offset + 20) & 0x03fffffc)),
9545 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 20);
9546 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[6],
9547 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 24);
9548 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[7],
9549 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 28);
9550 
9551 		/* Fill in the GOT entry corresponding to this PLT slot with
9552 		   the address immediately after the "bctr" instruction
9553 		   in this PLT entry.  */
9554 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, (plt->output_section->vma
9555 					       + plt->output_offset
9556 					       + ent->plt.offset + 16),
9557 			    htab->elf.sgotplt->contents + got_offset);
9558 
9559 		if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9560 		  {
9561 		    /* Fill in a couple of entries in .rela.plt.unloaded.  */
9562 		    loc = htab->srelplt2->contents
9563 		      + ((VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS + reloc_index
9564 			  * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS)
9565 			 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9566 
9567 		    /* Provide the @ha relocation for the first instruction.  */
9568 		    rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9569 				     + plt->output_offset
9570 				     + ent->plt.offset + 2);
9571 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9572 						R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
9573 		    rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9574 		    bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9575 		    loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9576 
9577 		    /* Provide the @l relocation for the second instruction.  */
9578 		    rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9579 				     + plt->output_offset
9580 				     + ent->plt.offset + 6);
9581 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9582 						R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
9583 		    rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9584 		    bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9585 		    loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9586 
9587 		    /* Provide a relocation for the GOT entry corresponding to this
9588 		       PLT slot.  Point it at the middle of the .plt entry.  */
9589 		    rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9590 				     + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9591 				     + got_offset);
9592 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx,
9593 						R_PPC_ADDR32);
9594 		    rela.r_addend = ent->plt.offset + 16;
9595 		    bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9596 		  }
9597 
9598 		/* VxWorks uses non-standard semantics for R_PPC_JMP_SLOT.
9599 		   In particular, the offset for the relocation is not the
9600 		   address of the PLT entry for this function, as specified
9601 		   by the ABI.  Instead, the offset is set to the address of
9602 		   the GOT slot for this function.  See EABI 4.4.4.1.  */
9603 		rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9604 				 + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9605 				 + got_offset);
9606 		rela.r_addend = 0;
9607 	      }
9608 	    else
9609 	      {
9610 		rela.r_addend = 0;
9611 		if (!dyn)
9612 		  {
9613 		    if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9614 		      {
9615 			plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9616 			relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9617 		      }
9618 		    else
9619 		      {
9620 			plt = htab->pltlocal;
9621 			relplt = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
9622 		      }
9623 		    if (h->def_regular
9624 			&& (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
9625 			    || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
9626 		      rela.r_addend = SYM_VAL (h);
9627 		  }
9628 
9629 		if (relplt == NULL)
9630 		  {
9631 		    loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9632 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, rela.r_addend, loc);
9633 		  }
9634 		else
9635 		  {
9636 		    rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9637 				     + plt->output_offset
9638 				     + ent->plt.offset);
9639 
9640 		    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD || !dyn)
9641 		      {
9642 			/* We don't need to fill in the .plt.  The ppc dynamic
9643 			   linker will fill it in.  */
9644 		      }
9645 		    else
9646 		      {
9647 			bfd_vma val = (htab->glink_pltresolve + ent->plt.offset
9648 				       + htab->glink->output_section->vma
9649 				       + htab->glink->output_offset);
9650 			bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val,
9651 				    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset);
9652 		      }
9653 		  }
9654 	      }
9655 
9656 	    if (relplt != NULL)
9657 	      {
9658 		/* Fill in the entry in the .rela.plt section.  */
9659 		if (!dyn)
9660 		  {
9661 		    if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9662 		      rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9663 		    else
9664 		      rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9665 		    loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9666 					      * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9667 		    htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9668 		  }
9669 		else
9670 		  {
9671 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_JMP_SLOT);
9672 		    loc = relplt->contents + (reloc_index
9673 					      * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9674 		    if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && is_static_defined (h))
9675 		      htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9676 		  }
9677 		bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9678 	      }
9679 	    doneone = true;
9680 	  }
9681 
9682 	if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
9683 	  {
9684 	    unsigned char *p;
9685 	    asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9686 
9687 	    if (!dyn)
9688 	      {
9689 		if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9690 		  plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9691 		else
9692 		  break;
9693 	      }
9694 
9695 	    p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9696 	    write_glink_stub (h, ent, plt, p, info);
9697 
9698 	    if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9699 	      /* We only need one non-PIC glink stub.  */
9700 	      break;
9701 	  }
9702 	else
9703 	  break;
9704       }
9705   return true;
9706 }
9707 
9708 /* Finish up PLT handling.  */
9709 
9710 bool
ppc_finish_symbols(struct bfd_link_info * info)9711 ppc_finish_symbols (struct bfd_link_info *info)
9712 {
9713   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9714   bfd *ibfd;
9715 
9716   if (!htab)
9717     return true;
9718 
9719   elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, write_global_sym_plt, info);
9720 
9721   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9722     {
9723       bfd_vma *local_got, *end_local_got;
9724       struct plt_entry **local_plt, **lplt, **end_local_plt;
9725       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9726       bfd_size_type locsymcount;
9727       Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
9728       struct plt_entry *ent;
9729 
9730       if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
9731 	continue;
9732 
9733       local_got = elf_local_got_offsets (ibfd);
9734       if (!local_got)
9735 	continue;
9736 
9737       symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
9738       locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
9739       end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
9740       local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
9741       end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
9742       for (lplt = local_plt; lplt < end_local_plt; ++lplt)
9743 	for (ent = *lplt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9744 	  {
9745 	    if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9746 	      {
9747 		Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
9748 		asection *sym_sec;
9749 		asection *plt, *relplt;
9750 		bfd_byte *loc;
9751 		bfd_vma val;
9752 		Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9753 		unsigned char *p;
9754 
9755 		if (!get_sym_h (NULL, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
9756 				lplt - local_plt, ibfd))
9757 		  {
9758 		    if (symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9759 		      free (local_syms);
9760 		    return false;
9761 		  }
9762 
9763 		val = sym->st_value;
9764 		if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
9765 		  val += sym_sec->output_offset + sym_sec->output_section->vma;
9766 
9767 		if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9768 		  {
9769 		    htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9770 		    plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9771 		    relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9772 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9773 		  }
9774 		else
9775 		  {
9776 		    plt = htab->pltlocal;
9777 		    if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9778 		      {
9779 			relplt = htab->relpltlocal;
9780 			rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9781 		      }
9782 		    else
9783 		      {
9784 			loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9785 			bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val, loc);
9786 			continue;
9787 		      }
9788 		  }
9789 
9790 		rela.r_offset = (ent->plt.offset
9791 				 + plt->output_offset
9792 				 + plt->output_section->vma);
9793 		rela.r_addend = val;
9794 		loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9795 					  * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9796 		bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9797 
9798 		p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9799 		write_glink_stub (NULL, ent, htab->elf.iplt, p, info);
9800 	      }
9801 	  }
9802 
9803       if (local_syms != NULL
9804 	  && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9805 	{
9806 	  if (!info->keep_memory)
9807 	    free (local_syms);
9808 	  else
9809 	    symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
9810 	}
9811     }
9812   return true;
9813 }
9814 
9815 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling.  We set the contents of various
9816    dynamic sections here.  */
9817 
9818 static bool
ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym)9819 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
9820 			       struct bfd_link_info *info,
9821 			       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
9822 			       Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
9823 {
9824   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9825   struct plt_entry *ent;
9826 
9827 #ifdef DEBUG
9828   fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol called for %s",
9829 	   h->root.root.string);
9830 #endif
9831 
9832   if (!h->def_regular
9833       || (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && !bfd_link_pic (info)))
9834     for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9835       if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9836 	{
9837 	  if (!h->def_regular)
9838 	    {
9839 	      /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as
9840 		 defined in the .plt section.  Leave the value if
9841 		 there were any relocations where pointer equality
9842 		 matters (this is a clue for the dynamic linker, to
9843 		 make function pointer comparisons work between an
9844 		 application and shared library), otherwise set it
9845 		 to zero.  */
9846 	      sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
9847 	      if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
9848 		sym->st_value = 0;
9849 	      else if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak)
9850 		{
9851 		  /* This breaks function pointer comparisons, but
9852 		     that is better than breaking tests for a NULL
9853 		     function pointer.  */
9854 		  sym->st_value = 0;
9855 		}
9856 	    }
9857 	  else
9858 	    {
9859 	      /* Set the value of ifunc symbols in a non-pie
9860 		 executable to the glink entry.  This is to avoid
9861 		 text relocations.  We can't do this for ifunc in
9862 		 allocate_dynrelocs, as we do for normal dynamic
9863 		 function symbols with plt entries, because we need
9864 		 to keep the original value around for the ifunc
9865 		 relocation.  */
9866 	      sym->st_shndx
9867 		= (_bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
9868 		   (info->output_bfd, htab->glink->output_section));
9869 	      sym->st_value = (ent->glink_offset
9870 			       + htab->glink->output_offset
9871 			       + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
9872 	    }
9873 	  break;
9874 	}
9875 
9876   if (h->needs_copy)
9877     {
9878       asection *s;
9879       Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9880       bfd_byte *loc;
9881 
9882       /* This symbols needs a copy reloc.  Set it up.  */
9883 
9884 #ifdef DEBUG
9885       fprintf (stderr, ", copy");
9886 #endif
9887 
9888       BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
9889 
9890       if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
9891 	s = htab->relsbss;
9892       else if (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
9893 	s = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
9894       else
9895 	s = htab->elf.srelbss;
9896       BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
9897 
9898       rela.r_offset = SYM_VAL (h);
9899       rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_COPY);
9900       rela.r_addend = 0;
9901       loc = s->contents + s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9902       bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9903     }
9904 
9905 #ifdef DEBUG
9906   fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9907 #endif
9908 
9909   return true;
9910 }
9911 
9912 static enum elf_reloc_type_class
ppc_elf_reloc_type_class(const struct bfd_link_info * info,const asection * rel_sec,const Elf_Internal_Rela * rela)9913 ppc_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info,
9914 			  const asection *rel_sec,
9915 			  const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
9916 {
9917   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9918 
9919   if (rel_sec == htab->elf.irelplt)
9920     return reloc_class_ifunc;
9921 
9922   switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rela->r_info))
9923     {
9924     case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
9925       return reloc_class_relative;
9926     case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
9927       return reloc_class_plt;
9928     case R_PPC_COPY:
9929       return reloc_class_copy;
9930     default:
9931       return reloc_class_normal;
9932     }
9933 }
9934 
9935 /* Finish up the dynamic sections.  */
9936 
9937 static bool
ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)9938 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
9939 				 struct bfd_link_info *info)
9940 {
9941   asection *sdyn;
9942   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9943   bfd_vma got;
9944   bfd *dynobj;
9945   bool ret = true;
9946 
9947 #ifdef DEBUG
9948   fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections called\n");
9949 #endif
9950 
9951   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9952   dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
9953   sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
9954 
9955   got = 0;
9956   if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
9957     got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9958 
9959   if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
9960     {
9961       Elf32_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend;
9962 
9963       BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.splt != NULL && sdyn != NULL);
9964 
9965       dyncon = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents;
9966       dynconend = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size);
9967       for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++)
9968 	{
9969 	  Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
9970 	  asection *s;
9971 
9972 	  bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
9973 
9974 	  switch (dyn.d_tag)
9975 	    {
9976 	    case DT_PLTGOT:
9977 	      if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks)
9978 		s = htab->elf.sgotplt;
9979 	      else
9980 		s = htab->elf.splt;
9981 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
9982 	      break;
9983 
9984 	    case DT_PLTRELSZ:
9985 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->elf.srelplt->size;
9986 	      break;
9987 
9988 	    case DT_JMPREL:
9989 	      s = htab->elf.srelplt;
9990 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
9991 	      break;
9992 
9993 	    case DT_PPC_GOT:
9994 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = got;
9995 	      break;
9996 
9997 	    case DT_TEXTREL:
9998 	      if (htab->local_ifunc_resolver)
9999 		info->callbacks->einfo
10000 		  (_("%X%P: text relocations and GNU indirect "
10001 		     "functions will result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
10002 	      else if (htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver)
10003 		info->callbacks->einfo
10004 		  (_("%P: warning: text relocations and GNU indirect "
10005 		     "functions may result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
10006 	      continue;
10007 
10008 	    default:
10009 	      if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
10010 		  && elf_vxworks_finish_dynamic_entry (output_bfd, &dyn))
10011 		break;
10012 	      continue;
10013 	    }
10014 
10015 	  bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
10016 	}
10017     }
10018 
10019   if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
10020       && htab->elf.sgot->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
10021     {
10022       if (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgot
10023 	  || htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgotplt)
10024 	{
10025 	  unsigned char *p = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->contents;
10026 
10027 	  p += htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
10028 	  if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
10029 	    {
10030 	      /* Add a blrl instruction at _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_-4
10031 		 so that a function can easily find the address of
10032 		 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_.  */
10033 	      BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value - 4
10034 			  < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
10035 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0x4e800021, p - 4);
10036 	    }
10037 
10038 	  if (sdyn != NULL)
10039 	    {
10040 	      bfd_vma val = sdyn->output_section->vma + sdyn->output_offset;
10041 	      BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value
10042 			  < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
10043 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, val, p);
10044 	    }
10045 	}
10046       else
10047 	{
10048 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
10049 	  _bfd_error_handler (_("%s not defined in linker created %pA"),
10050 			      htab->elf.hgot->root.root.string,
10051 			      (htab->elf.sgotplt != NULL
10052 			       ? htab->elf.sgotplt : htab->elf.sgot));
10053 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
10054 	  ret = false;
10055 	}
10056 
10057       elf_section_data (htab->elf.sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize = 4;
10058     }
10059 
10060   /* Fill in the first entry in the VxWorks procedure linkage table.  */
10061   if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
10062       && htab->elf.splt != NULL
10063       && htab->elf.splt->size != 0
10064       && htab->elf.splt->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
10065     {
10066       asection *splt = htab->elf.splt;
10067       /* Use the right PLT. */
10068       const bfd_vma *plt_entry = (bfd_link_pic (info)
10069 				  ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
10070 				  : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry);
10071 
10072       if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
10073 	{
10074 	  bfd_vma got_value = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
10075 
10076 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_value),
10077 		      splt->contents +  0);
10078 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_value),
10079 		      splt->contents +  4);
10080 	}
10081       else
10082 	{
10083 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0], splt->contents +  0);
10084 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1], splt->contents +  4);
10085 	}
10086       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], splt->contents +  8);
10087       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], splt->contents + 12);
10088       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], splt->contents + 16);
10089       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], splt->contents + 20);
10090       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], splt->contents + 24);
10091       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], splt->contents + 28);
10092 
10093       if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
10094 	{
10095 	  Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
10096 	  bfd_byte *loc;
10097 
10098 	  loc = htab->srelplt2->contents;
10099 
10100 	  /* Output the @ha relocation for the first instruction.  */
10101 	  rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10102 			   + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10103 			   + 2);
10104 	  rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10105 	  rela.r_addend = 0;
10106 	  bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10107 	  loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10108 
10109 	  /* Output the @l relocation for the second instruction.  */
10110 	  rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10111 			   + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10112 			   + 6);
10113 	  rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10114 	  rela.r_addend = 0;
10115 	  bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10116 	  loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10117 
10118 	  /* Fix up the remaining relocations.  They may have the wrong
10119 	     symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order
10120 	     in which symbols were output.  */
10121 	  while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size)
10122 	    {
10123 	      Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
10124 
10125 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10126 	      rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10127 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10128 	      loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10129 
10130 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10131 	      rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10132 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10133 	      loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10134 
10135 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10136 	      rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx, R_PPC_ADDR32);
10137 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10138 	      loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10139 	    }
10140 	}
10141     }
10142 
10143   if (htab->glink != NULL
10144       && htab->glink->contents != NULL
10145       && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
10146     {
10147       unsigned char *p;
10148       unsigned char *endp;
10149       bfd_vma res0;
10150 
10151       /*
10152        * PIC glink code is the following:
10153        *
10154        * # ith PLT code stub.
10155        *   addis 11,30,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@ha
10156        *   lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@l(11)
10157        *   mtctr 11
10158        *   bctr
10159        *
10160        * # A table of branches, one for each plt entry.
10161        * # The idea is that the plt call stub loads ctr and r11 with these
10162        * # addresses, so (r11 - res_0) gives the plt index * 4.
10163        * res_0:	b PLTresolve
10164        * res_1:	b PLTresolve
10165        * .
10166        * # Some number of entries towards the end can be nops
10167        * res_n_m3: nop
10168        * res_n_m2: nop
10169        * res_n_m1:
10170        *
10171        * PLTresolve:
10172        *    addis 11,11,(1f-res_0)@ha
10173        *    mflr 0
10174        *    bcl 20,31,1f
10175        * 1: addi 11,11,(1b-res_0)@l
10176        *    mflr 12
10177        *    mtlr 0
10178        *    sub 11,11,12		# r11 = index * 4
10179        *    addis 12,12,(got+4-1b)@ha
10180        *    lwz 0,(got+4-1b)@l(12)	# got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10181        *    lwz 12,(got+8-1b)@l(12)	# got[2] contains the map address
10182        *    mtctr 0
10183        *    add 0,11,11
10184        *    add 11,0,11			# r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10185        *    bctr
10186        *
10187        * Non-PIC glink code is a little simpler.
10188        *
10189        * # ith PLT code stub.
10190        *   lis 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@ha
10191        *   lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@l(11)
10192        *   mtctr 11
10193        *   bctr
10194        *
10195        * The branch table is the same, then comes
10196        *
10197        * PLTresolve:
10198        *    lis 12,(got+4)@ha
10199        *    addis 11,11,(-res_0)@ha
10200        *    lwz 0,(got+4)@l(12)		# got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10201        *    addi 11,11,(-res_0)@l	# r11 = index * 4
10202        *    mtctr 0
10203        *    add 0,11,11
10204        *    lwz 12,(got+8)@l(12)	# got[2] contains the map address
10205        *    add 11,0,11			# r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10206        *    bctr
10207        */
10208 
10209       /* Build the branch table, one for each plt entry (less one),
10210 	 and perhaps some padding.  */
10211       p = htab->glink->contents;
10212       p += htab->glink_pltresolve;
10213       endp = htab->glink->contents;
10214       endp += htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10215       while (p < endp - (htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 0 : 8 * 4))
10216 	{
10217 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B + endp - p, p);
10218 	  p += 4;
10219 	}
10220       while (p < endp)
10221 	{
10222 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
10223 	  p += 4;
10224 	}
10225 
10226       res0 = (htab->glink_pltresolve
10227 	      + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10228 	      + htab->glink->output_offset);
10229 
10230       if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround)
10231 	{
10232 	  /* Ensure that a call stub at the end of a page doesn't
10233 	     result in prefetch over the end of the page into the
10234 	     glink branch table.  */
10235 	  bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
10236 	  bfd_vma page_addr;
10237 	  bfd_vma glink_start = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10238 				 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10239 
10240 	  for (page_addr = res0 & -pagesize;
10241 	       page_addr > glink_start;
10242 	       page_addr -= pagesize)
10243 	    {
10244 	      /* We have a plt call stub that may need fixing.  */
10245 	      bfd_byte *loc;
10246 	      unsigned int insn;
10247 
10248 	      loc = htab->glink->contents + page_addr - 4 - glink_start;
10249 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
10250 	      if (insn == BCTR)
10251 		{
10252 		  /* By alignment, we know that there must be at least
10253 		     one other call stub before this one.  */
10254 		  insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc - 16);
10255 		  if (insn == BCTR)
10256 		    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-16 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10257 		  else
10258 		    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-20 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10259 		}
10260 	    }
10261 	}
10262 
10263       /* Last comes the PLTresolve stub.  */
10264       endp = p + GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10265       if (bfd_link_pic (info))
10266 	{
10267 	  bfd_vma bcl;
10268 
10269 	  bcl = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 3*4
10270 		 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10271 		 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10272 
10273 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (bcl - res0), p);
10274 	  p += 4;
10275 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_0, p);
10276 	  p += 4;
10277 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCL_20_31, p);
10278 	  p += 4;
10279 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (bcl - res0), p);
10280 	  p += 4;
10281 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_12, p);
10282 	  p += 4;
10283 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTLR_0, p);
10284 	  p += 4;
10285 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, SUB_11_11_12, p);
10286 	  p += 4;
10287 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_12_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10288 	  p += 4;
10289 	  if (PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl) == PPC_HA (got + 8 - bcl))
10290 	    {
10291 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10292 	      p += 4;
10293 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8 - bcl), p);
10294 	      p += 4;
10295 	    }
10296 	  else
10297 	    {
10298 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10299 	      p += 4;
10300 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10301 	      p += 4;
10302 	    }
10303 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10304 	  p += 4;
10305 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10306 	}
10307       else
10308 	{
10309 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4), p);
10310 	  p += 4;
10311 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (-res0), p);
10312 	  p += 4;
10313 	  if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10314 	    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10315 	  else
10316 	    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10317 	  p += 4;
10318 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (-res0), p);
10319 	  p += 4;
10320 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10321 	  p += 4;
10322 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10323 	  p += 4;
10324 	  if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10325 	    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8), p);
10326 	  else
10327 	    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10328 	}
10329       p += 4;
10330       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_11_0_11, p);
10331       p += 4;
10332       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
10333       p += 4;
10334       while (p < endp)
10335 	{
10336 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
10337 		      htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
10338 	  p += 4;
10339 	}
10340       BFD_ASSERT (p == endp);
10341     }
10342 
10343   if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
10344       && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
10345     {
10346       unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10347       bfd_vma val;
10348 
10349       p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
10350       /* FDE length.  */
10351       p += 4;
10352       /* CIE pointer.  */
10353       p += 4;
10354       /* Offset to .glink.  */
10355       val = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10356 	     + htab->glink->output_offset);
10357       val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
10358 	      + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset);
10359       val -= p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10360       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
10361 
10362       if (htab->glink_eh_frame->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME
10363 	  && !_bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame (output_bfd, info,
10364 					       htab->glink_eh_frame,
10365 					       htab->glink_eh_frame->contents))
10366 	return false;
10367     }
10368 
10369   return ret;
10370 }
10371 
10372 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM	powerpc_elf32_le_vec
10373 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME	"elf32-powerpcle"
10374 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM		powerpc_elf32_vec
10375 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME		"elf32-powerpc"
10376 #define ELF_ARCH		bfd_arch_powerpc
10377 #define ELF_TARGET_ID		PPC32_ELF_DATA
10378 #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE	EM_PPC
10379 #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE		0x10000
10380 #define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE	0x1000
10381 #define elf_info_to_howto	ppc_elf_info_to_howto
10382 
10383 #ifdef  EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10384 #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT1	EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10385 #endif
10386 
10387 #ifdef EM_PPC_OLD
10388 #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT2	EM_PPC_OLD
10389 #endif
10390 
10391 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded	1
10392 #define elf_backend_want_dynrelro	1
10393 #define elf_backend_can_gc_sections	1
10394 #define elf_backend_can_refcount	1
10395 #define elf_backend_rela_normal		1
10396 #define elf_backend_caches_rawsize	1
10397 
10398 #define bfd_elf32_mkobject			ppc_elf_mkobject
10399 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data	ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data
10400 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_relax_section		ppc_elf_relax_section
10401 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_type_lookup		ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup
10402 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_name_lookup		ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup
10403 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_set_private_flags		ppc_elf_set_private_flags
10404 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create	ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create
10405 #define bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab		ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab
10406 
10407 #define elf_backend_object_p			ppc_elf_object_p
10408 #define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook		ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook
10409 #define elf_backend_section_from_shdr		ppc_elf_section_from_shdr
10410 #define elf_backend_relocate_section		ppc_elf_relocate_section
10411 #define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections	ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections
10412 #define elf_backend_check_relocs		ppc_elf_check_relocs
10413 #define elf_backend_relocs_compatible		_bfd_elf_relocs_compatible
10414 #define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol	ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol
10415 #define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol	ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol
10416 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook		ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook
10417 #define elf_backend_size_dynamic_sections	ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections
10418 #define elf_backend_hash_symbol			ppc_elf_hash_symbol
10419 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol	ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol
10420 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections	ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections
10421 #define elf_backend_fake_sections		ppc_elf_fake_sections
10422 #define elf_backend_additional_program_headers	ppc_elf_additional_program_headers
10423 #define elf_backend_modify_segment_map		ppc_elf_modify_segment_map
10424 #define elf_backend_grok_prstatus		ppc_elf_grok_prstatus
10425 #define elf_backend_grok_psinfo			ppc_elf_grok_psinfo
10426 #define elf_backend_write_core_note		ppc_elf_write_core_note
10427 #define elf_backend_reloc_type_class		ppc_elf_reloc_type_class
10428 #define elf_backend_begin_write_processing	ppc_elf_begin_write_processing
10429 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing	ppc_elf_final_write_processing
10430 #define elf_backend_write_section		ppc_elf_write_section
10431 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr		ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr
10432 #define elf_backend_plt_sym_val			ppc_elf_plt_sym_val
10433 #define elf_backend_action_discarded		ppc_elf_action_discarded
10434 #define elf_backend_init_index_section		_bfd_elf_init_1_index_section
10435 #define elf_backend_lookup_section_flags_hook	ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags
10436 
10437 #include "elf32-target.h"
10438 
10439 /* FreeBSD Target */
10440 
10441 #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10442 #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10443 
10444 #undef  TARGET_BIG_SYM
10445 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM  powerpc_elf32_fbsd_vec
10446 #undef  TARGET_BIG_NAME
10447 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-freebsd"
10448 
10449 #undef  ELF_OSABI
10450 #define ELF_OSABI	ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
10451 
10452 #undef  elf32_bed
10453 #define elf32_bed	elf32_powerpc_fbsd_bed
10454 
10455 #include "elf32-target.h"
10456 
10457 /* VxWorks Target */
10458 
10459 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10460 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10461 
10462 #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10463 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM		powerpc_elf32_vxworks_vec
10464 #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10465 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME		"elf32-powerpc-vxworks"
10466 
10467 #undef  ELF_OSABI
10468 
10469 #undef ELF_TARGET_OS
10470 #define ELF_TARGET_OS		is_vxworks
10471 
10472 /* VxWorks uses the elf default section flags for .plt.  */
10473 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr(bfd * abfd,asection * sec)10474 ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
10475 {
10476   if (sec->name == NULL)
10477     return NULL;
10478 
10479   if (strcmp (sec->name, ".plt") == 0)
10480     return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10481 
10482   return ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10483 }
10484 
10485 /* Like ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create, but overrides
10486    appropriately for VxWorks.  */
10487 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create(bfd * abfd)10488 ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
10489 {
10490   struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
10491 
10492   ret = ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
10493   if (ret)
10494     {
10495       struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab
10496 	= (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *)ret;
10497       htab->plt_type = PLT_VXWORKS;
10498       htab->plt_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10499       htab->plt_slot_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10500       htab->plt_initial_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE;
10501     }
10502   return ret;
10503 }
10504 
10505 /* Tweak magic VxWorks symbols as they are loaded.  */
10506 static bool
ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym,const char ** namep,flagword * flagsp,asection ** secp,bfd_vma * valp)10507 ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
10508 				 struct bfd_link_info *info,
10509 				 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
10510 				 const char **namep,
10511 				 flagword *flagsp,
10512 				 asection **secp,
10513 				 bfd_vma *valp)
10514 {
10515   if (!elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp,
10516 				    valp))
10517     return false;
10518 
10519   return ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp, valp);
10520 }
10521 
10522 static bool
ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing(bfd * abfd)10523 ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
10524 {
10525   ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
10526   return elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (abfd);
10527 }
10528 
10529 /* On VxWorks, we emit relocations against _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_, so
10530    define it.  */
10531 #undef elf_backend_want_plt_sym
10532 #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym		1
10533 #undef elf_backend_want_got_plt
10534 #define elf_backend_want_got_plt		1
10535 #undef elf_backend_got_symbol_offset
10536 #define elf_backend_got_symbol_offset		0
10537 #undef elf_backend_plt_not_loaded
10538 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded		0
10539 #undef elf_backend_plt_readonly
10540 #define elf_backend_plt_readonly		1
10541 #undef elf_backend_got_header_size
10542 #define elf_backend_got_header_size		12
10543 #undef elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt
10544 #define elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt		1
10545 
10546 #undef bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab
10547 
10548 #undef bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create
10549 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create \
10550   ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create
10551 #undef elf_backend_add_symbol_hook
10552 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook \
10553   ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook
10554 #undef elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook
10555 #define elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook \
10556   elf_vxworks_link_output_symbol_hook
10557 #undef elf_backend_final_write_processing
10558 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing \
10559   ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing
10560 #undef elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr
10561 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr \
10562   ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr
10563 #undef elf_backend_emit_relocs
10564 #define elf_backend_emit_relocs \
10565   elf_vxworks_emit_relocs
10566 
10567 #undef elf32_bed
10568 #define elf32_bed				ppc_elf_vxworks_bed
10569 
10570 #include "elf32-target.h"
10571